Panasonic DMR EX77 User Manual

Operating Instructions  
DVD Recorder  
Model No. DMR-EX77  
d
e
t
r
a
ting  
e
G
DMR-EX87  
st  
ing  
w
e
Region number supported by  
Vi  
this unit  
Region numbers are allocated to DVD Recorders  
and DVD-Video according to where they are  
sold.  
The illustrations in these Operating Instructions show images of DMR-EX77.  
The region number of this unit is “4”.  
The unit will play DVD-Video marked with  
labels containing “4” or “ALL”.  
Example:  
g
in  
d
r
2
3
eco  
R
4
ALL  
4
k
c
gba  
in  
y
Dear customer  
Pla  
Thank you for purchasing this product. For optimum  
performance and safety, please read these  
instructions carefully.  
Before connecting, operating or adjusting this  
product, please read the instructions completely.  
Please keep this manual for future reference.  
Edting  
This DVD Recorder is for viewing and  
recording free to view channels only, not pay  
TV or encrypted channels.  
Trademark of the DVB Digital Video  
Broadcasting Project (1991 to 1996)  
ing  
y
Declaration of Conformity No. 4675,  
28th March 2007 (DMR-EX77)  
Cop  
Declaration of Conformity No. 4674,  
28th March 2007 (DMR-EX87)  
Notice for DVB functions  
Any function related to DVB (Digital Video  
Broadcasting) will work in areas where  
DVB-T (MPEG2) digital terrestrial  
broadcasting is received. Consult your local  
Panasonic dealer with coverage areas.  
This unit has the capability for DVB  
specifications. But future DVB services  
cannot be guaranteed.  
nt  
s
ie  
n
e
v
tion  
c
fun  
Con  
This unit does not support MHP (Multimedia  
Home Platform).  
e
nc  
e
r
e
f
Re  
GN  
RQT8859-L  
Table of contents  
Getting started  
Editing  
HDD, disc and card information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4  
Important notes for recording . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8  
HDD (Hard disk drive) handling care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9  
Disc and card handling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10  
Unit care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10  
Included accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11  
The remote control information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11  
Control reference guide . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12  
Remote control. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12  
Main unit. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13  
The unit’s display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13  
Editing titles/chapters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44  
Editing titles/chapters and playing chapters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44  
Title operations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45  
Chapter operations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45  
Creating, editing and playing playlists . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46  
Creating playlists. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46  
Editing and playing playlists/chapters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47  
Playlist operations. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47  
Chapter operations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47  
Editing still pictures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48  
Album and picture operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49  
STEP 1 Connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .14  
Connecting with an HDMI (High Definition Multimedia  
Delete Navigator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50  
Using the DELETE Navigator to delete. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50  
Deleting titles or pictures during play . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50  
Interface) terminal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17  
VIERA Link “HDAVI Control TM” . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18  
Easy control only with VIERA remote control. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19  
STEP 2 Channel reception settings and TV aspect  
settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .20  
STEP 3 Set up to match your television  
Copying  
Copying titles or playlists . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51  
Copy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52  
Copying using the copying list–Advanced Copy . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53  
Copying a finalised DVD-R, DVD-R DL,  
DVD-RW (DVD-Video format), +R and +R DL . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55  
Copying SD Video from an SD Card. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55  
and remote control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .21  
To enjoy progressive video . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21  
Viewing  
Copying still pictures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56  
Copying using the copying list. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56  
Copying all the still pictures on a card—Copy All Pictures . . . . . 57  
Copying from a video cassette recorder . . . . . . . . . . . 58  
Manual recording . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58  
DV automatic recording (DV Auto Rec) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58  
Watching analogue and digital broadcasts . . . . . . . . . 23  
Select the channel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23  
Digital channel information. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23  
Recording  
Recording television programmes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24  
Disc Insertion/Ejection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25  
To specify a time to stop recording—One Touch Recording . . . 26  
Recording settings for High Speed Copy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26  
Flexible Recording . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27  
Playing while you are recording . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27  
Convenient functions  
Entering text . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59  
HDD, disc and card management . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60  
Common procedures. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60  
Setting the protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60  
Providing a name for a disc. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60  
Deleting all titles and playlists—Delete all titles . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61  
Deleting all the contents of a disc or card—Format . . . . . . . . . . 61  
Selecting the background style—Top Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62  
Selecting whether to show the Top Menu first  
Timer recording . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28  
Using the TV Guide system to make timer recordings  
(Digital broadcast only) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28  
Operations in the TV Guide system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29  
Using G-CODE system to make timer recordings . . . . . . . . . . . . 30  
Manually programming timer recordings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31  
To cancel recording when recording has already begun . . . . . . 32  
To release the unit from recording standby . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32  
Notes on timer recording . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32  
Check, change or delete a programme . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33  
Relief Recording. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33  
Auto Renewal Recording . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33  
—Auto-Play Select . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62  
Enabling discs to be played on other equipment—Finalise . . . . 62  
Creating Top Menu—Create Top Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62  
FUNCTION MENU window . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63  
Child Lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63  
Changing the unit’s settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 64  
Common procedures. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 64  
Summary of settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 64  
Tuning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69  
TV System. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72  
Clock Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73  
Playing back  
Playing recorded video contents/  
Playing play-only discs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34  
Operations during play . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35  
Changing audio during play . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36  
Reference  
Messages. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74  
Frequently asked questions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 76  
Troubleshooting guide. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78  
Glossary. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 84  
Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86  
Safety precautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 87  
Index. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Back cover  
Playing DivX discs, MP3 discs and  
still pictures (JPEG) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37  
Regarding DivX discs, MP3 discs and still pictures (JPEG). . . . 37  
Selecting file type to play . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38  
Playing DivX discs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38  
Playing MP3 discs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39  
Playing still pictures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40  
Useful functions during still picture play . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41  
About descriptions in these operating instructions  
These operating instructions are applicable to models  
DMR-EX77 and DMR-EX87. Unless otherwise indicated,  
illustrations in these operating instructions are of DMR-EX77.  
[EX77] : indicates features applicable to DMR-EX77 only.  
[EX87] : indicates features applicable to DMR-EX87 only.  
Pages to be referred to are indicated as “{{”.  
Using on-screen menus/Status message. . . . . . . . . . . 42  
Using on-screen menus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42  
Status messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43  
RQT8859  
3
HDD, disc and card information  
HDD and discs you can use for recording and play  
Hard disk drive (HDD)  
[EX77] 160 GB  
DVD-RAM  
4.7 GB/9.4 GB, 12 cm  
Disc type  
[EX87] 250 GB  
2.8 GB, 8 cm  
Logo  
Indicated in these  
instructions by  
[HDD]  
[RAM]  
DVD Video Recording format  
This is a recording format which allows you to record and edit television broadcasts and so on.  
You can delete unwanted parts of a title, create playlists, etc.  
Recording format  
The broadcasts that allow “One time only recording” can be recorded to a CPRM compatible disc.  
Data that can be recorded  
and played  
Video  
Still pictures  
Video  
Still pictures  
Re-writable  
Play on other players§2  
Only on DVD-RAM compatible players.  
Compatible with high  
speed recording§3  
Up to 5X recording speed discs.  
What you can do on this unit (: Can do, –: Cannot do)  
Recording broadcasts that  
allow one copy  
[CPRM (84) compatible discs only.]  
Recording both M 1 and  
M 2 for bilingual  
broadcasts§4  
Recording 16:9 aspect  
picture§4  
Creating and editing  
playlists  
DVD-R DL§1  
(dual layer on single side)  
You cannot directly record to a  
DVD-R DL disc on this unit (8)  
DVD-R§1  
4.7 GB, 12 cm  
1.4 GB, 8 cm  
DVD-RW  
4.7 GB, 12 cm  
1.4 GB, 8 cm  
Disc type  
Logo  
[-R] before finalisation  
[-R]DL] before finalisation  
[-RW‹V›] before finalisation  
Indicated in these  
instructions by  
[DVD-V] after finalisation  
[DVD-V] after finalisation  
[DVD-V] after finalisation  
DVD-Video format  
This recording format is the same as commercially available DVD-Video.  
Recording format  
The broadcasts that allow “One time only recording” cannot be recorded.  
Data that can be recorded  
and played  
Video  
Video  
Video  
Re-writable  
Only on DVD-R DL compatible  
players after finalising the disc  
(62, 84).  
Only after finalising the disc  
Play on other players§2  
Only after finalising the disc (62, 84).  
(62, 84).  
Compatible with high  
speed recording§3  
Up to 16X recording speed discs.  
Up to 8X recording speed discs.  
Up to 6X recording speed discs.  
What you can do on this unit (: Can do, –: Cannot do)  
Recording broadcasts that  
allow one copy  
Recording both M 1 and  
[Only one is recorded.(66, Bilingual  
[Only one is recorded.(66,  
Bilingual Audio Selection)]  
[Only one is recorded.(66,  
Bilingual Audio Selection)]  
M 2 for bilingual  
Audio Selection)]  
broadcasts§4  
Recording 16:9 aspect  
picture§4  
Creating and editing  
playlists  
RQT8859  
(continued on the next page)  
4
HDD and discs you can use for recording and play  
(continued)  
+R DL§1  
(double layer on single side)  
You cannot directly record to a  
+R DL disc on this unit (8)  
+R§1 §5  
4.7 GB, 12 cm  
Disc type  
Logo  
+RW  
ion  
[+R] before finalisation  
[DVD-V] after finalisation  
[+R]DL] before finalisation  
[DVD-V] after finalisation  
Indicated in these  
instructions by  
[+RW]  
rmat  
o
+VR (+R/+RW Video Recording) format  
This is a format for recording moving pictures to +R/+RW discs.  
inf  
d
r
You can playback such discs recorded in this format in a similar way as contents recorded in the DVD-Video  
format.  
Recording format  
a
The broadcasts that allow “One time only recording” cannot be recorded.  
After finalising the disc or creating the top menu, you can play the disc on DVD players and other equipment.  
andc  
c
Data that can be recorded  
and played  
Video  
Video  
Video  
,dis  
Re-writable  
Play on other players§2  
Only on +R DL compatible players  
after finalising the disc (62, 84).  
Only after finalising the disc (62, 84).  
Only on +RW compatible players.  
HD  
Compatible with high  
speed recording§3  
Up to 16X recording speed discs.  
Up to 8X recording speed discs.  
Up to 4X recording speed discs.§6  
What you can do on this unit (: Can do, –: Cannot do)  
Recording broadcasts that  
allow one copy  
Recording both M 1 and  
[Only one is recorded.(66,  
M 2 for bilingual  
[Only one is recorded.(66,  
Bilingual Audio Selection)]  
[Only one is recorded.(66,  
Bilingual Audio Selection)]  
Bilingual Audio Selection)]  
broadcasts§4  
Recording 16:9 aspect  
picture§4  
(The picture is recorded in 4:3  
(The picture is recorded in 4:3  
(The picture is recorded in 4:3  
aspect.)  
aspect.)  
aspect.)  
Creating and editing playlists  
§1  
The amount of the recordable disc space doesn’t increase even if the programme is deleted when you use discs that can only be used for  
recording once.  
[RAM] Can be played on Panasonic DVD Recorders and DVD-RAM compatible DVD players.  
If you play a DVD-R DL, +R DL or +RW, use compatible equipment.  
The high speed recording discs listed here are compatible with this unit. However, this is not the copy speed.  
For further information (8, Important notes for recording)  
§2  
§3  
§4  
[Note]  
When “Rec for High Speed Copy” is set to “On”, the restrictions on secondary audio recording are also applied to DVD-RAM. Turn this setting  
“Off” if high speed copy to DVD-R, etc. is not necessary when recording a programme (The default setting is “On”. 65).  
+R discs recorded with this unit and +R discs recorded with another Panasonic DVD Recorder may be incompatible. However, discs that are  
finalised are compatible and can be played.  
§5  
§6  
You can play 8X recording speed discs recorded on another equipment.  
We recommend using Panasonic discs and cards. We also recommend using DVD-RAM discs with cartridges to protect them from scratches  
and dirt.  
You may not be able to record depending on the condition of the discs and you may not be able to play due to the condition of the recording.  
You cannot record programmes that allow “One time only recording” to CPRM compatible DVD-R and DVD-RW on this unit.  
This unit cannot record NTSC signals to discs that already have PAL signal recordings. (However, both types of programmes can be recorded  
onto the HDD.)  
Finalise  
A process that makes play of a recorded disc possible on equipment that can play such media. After finalising, the disc becomes play-only and  
you can no longer record or edit. (62)  
Formatting  
Formatting is the process of making media such as DVD-RAM recordable on recording equipment. (61)  
Formatting permanently deletes all contents.  
You cannot directly record to a DVD-R DL and +R DL disc on this unit.  
Record to the HDD and then copy to the disc.  
When playing DVD-R DL (Dual Layer, single-sided) and +R DL (Double Layer, single-sided)  
DVD-R DL (Dual Layer, single-sided) and +R DL  
(Double Layer, single-sided) discs have two writable  
layers on one side. If there is not enough space on the  
first layer to record a programme, the remainder is  
recorded on the second layer. When playing a title  
When switching layers:  
Video and audio may momentarily cut  
recorded on both layers, the unit automatically  
switches between layers and plays the title in the same  
way as a normal programme. However, video and  
audio may momentarily cut out when the unit is  
switching layers.  
Second recordable layer  
The available  
space  
(Inner  
section of the  
disc)  
(Outersection  
of the disc)  
First recordable layer  
DVD-R DL  
+R DL  
Title 1  
Title 2  
Playback direction  
RQT8859  
5
Recording modes and approximate recording times (25)  
HDD, disc and card information  
Play-only discs (12 cm/8 cm)  
Disc type  
DVD-Video  
DVD-RW (DVD Video Recording format)  
Logo  
Indicated in  
these  
[DVD-V]  
[-RW‹VR›]  
instructions by  
Instructions  
High quality movie and music discs  
DVD-RW recorded on another DVD Recorder  
You can play programmes that allow “One time only recording” if they have been  
recorded to a CPRM compatible disc.  
By formatting (61) the disc, you can record to it in DVD-Video format and play it  
on this unit.  
It may be necessary to finalise the disc on the equipment used for recording.  
.
Disc type  
Logo  
DVD-R  
DVD-R DL  
CD  
Video CD  
Indicated in  
these  
DivX  
DivX  
[CD]  
DivX, MP3, JPEG  
[VCD]  
instructions by  
Instructions  
DVD-R§ with video DVD-R DL§ with  
CD-R and CD-RW§ with  
video recorded in DivX  
Recorded audio and  
music (including CD-  
R/RW§)  
Recorded music and  
video (including CD-R/  
RW§)  
recorded in DivX  
video recorded in  
DivX  
CD-R and CD-RW§ with  
music recorded in MP3  
CD-R and CD-RW§ with still  
pictures recorded in JPEG  
§ Close the session after recording. Play may be impossible on some discs due to the condition of the recording.  
The producer of the disc can control how discs are played. So you may not always be able to control play as described in these operating  
instructions. Read the disc’s instructions carefully.  
Operation and sound quality of CDs that do not conform to CD-DA specifications (copy control CDs, etc.) cannot be guaranteed.  
Discs that cannot be played  
2.6 and 5.2 GB DVD-RAM, 12 cm  
3.95 and 4.7 GB DVD-R for Authoring  
DVD-R, DVD-R DL, DVD-RW, +R, +R DL recorded on another unit  
and not finalised (84).  
Types of disc or title recorded on HDD  
for the type of connected TV  
When you use the discs recorded either PAL or NTSC, or playback a  
title recorded on HDD using PAL or NTSC, refer to this table.  
(: Possible to view, : Impossible to view)  
Discs recorded with AVCHD format.  
DVD-Video with a region number other than “4” or “ALL”  
DVD-Audio  
Disc/Titles  
recorded on HDD  
TV type  
Yes/No  
Blu-ray, HD DVD  
DVD-ROM, +R (8 cm), CD-ROM, CDV, CD-G, Photo CD, CVD,  
SVCD, SACD, MV-Disc, PD, etc.  
PAL  
NTSC  
PAL  
Multi-system TV  
PAL TV  
§1 (PAL60)  
NTSC  
PAL  
NTSC TV  
§2  
NTSC  
§1  
If your television is not equipped to handle PAL 525/60 signals  
the picture will not be shown correctly.  
Select “NTSC” in “TV System” (72).  
§2  
When playing back a title recorded on the HDD, ensure that you  
match the “TV System” setting to the title (PAL or NTSC) (72).  
RQT8859  
6
Cards you can use on this unit  
Type  
SD Memory Card (from 8 MB to 2 GB)  
SDHC Memory Card (4 GB)  
miniSD Card§  
MultiMediaCard  
The card types mentioned above will be referred to as “SD Card” in these operating instructions.  
ion  
Indicated in these instructions  
by  
[SD]  
rmat  
o
inf  
Data that can be recorded and  
played  
Still pictures  
Video (SD Video)  
d
r
a
Instructions  
You can insert directly into the SD Card slot.  
§ A miniSD card adaptor included with the miniSD card is necessary.  
You can play and copy still pictures taken on a digital camera etc. (40, 56).  
SD Video shot with a Panasonic SD Video camera, etc. can be copied to the HDD or DVD-RAM.  
(55)  
andc  
c
,dis  
SD Video cannot be played directly from the SD Card.  
HD  
Suitable SD Cards  
When using 4 GB SD Memory Cards, only SD Memory Cards that display the SDHC logo can be used.  
Useable memory is slightly less than the card capacity.  
Please confirm the latest information on the following website.  
(This site is in English only.)  
If the SD Card is formatted on other equipment, the time necessary for recording may be longer. Also, if the SD Card is formatted on a PC, you  
may not be able to use it on this unit. In these cases, format the card on this unit (61, 84).  
This unit is compatible with SD Memory Cards that meet SD Card Specifications FAT 12 and FAT 16 formats, as well as SDHC Memory Cards  
in FAT 32 format.  
SDHC Memory Cards used for recording with this unit can only be used with other SDHC Memory Card-compatible equipment. SDHC Memory  
Cards cannot be used with equipment that is only compatible with SD Memory Cards.  
This unit cannot play AVCHD format motion pictures on an SD Card.  
We recommend using a Panasonic SD Card.  
Keep the Memory Card out of reach of children to prevent swallowing.  
Structure of folders displayed by this unit  
The following  
can be displayed on this unit.  
XXX: Letters  
¢¢¢: Numbers  
Card  
DVD-RAM  
(Higher folder)  
DCIM  
(Picture folder)  
¢¢¢XXXXX  
JPEG  
XXXX¢¢¢¢.JPG  
(Higher folder)  
DCIM¢¢¢  
(Picture folder)  
¢¢¢XXXXX  
§
IM¢¢CDPF or IMEXPORT  
XXXX¢¢¢¢.JPG  
XXXX¢¢¢¢.JPG  
§
DCIM  
¢¢¢XXXXX  
XXXX¢¢¢¢.JPG  
SD_VIDEO  
(MPEG2 folder)  
PRG¢¢¢  
MOV¢¢¢.MOD  
MOV¢¢¢.MOI  
PRG¢¢¢.PGI  
(MPEG2 information folder)  
MGR_INFO  
§ Folders can be created on other equipment. However, these folders cannot be selected as a copying destination.  
The folder cannot be displayed if the numbers are all “0” (e.g., DCIM000, etc.).  
If a folder name or file name has been input using other equipment, the name may not be displayed properly or you may not be able to play  
or edit the data.  
RQT8859  
7
Important notes for recording  
Broadcast in multi-channel sound (Digital broadcast  
only):  
You can select the audio language when receiving audio in  
multi channel broadcast [“Multi Audio” appears at the  
bottom of digital channel information display (23)].  
However, audio cannot be switched after recording.  
Selecting Audio  
for Recording  
Hello  
Hola  
Hallo  
Select the audio that you  
want to record in “DVB  
Multi Audio” in the on-  
screen menu (43).  
Bilingual broadcasts (Analogue broadcast only):  
[HDD] [RAM]  
Both main and secondary audio can be recorded.  
You can change the audio during playback.  
(36, Changing audio during play)  
[-R] [-RW‹V›] [+R] [+RW]  
Select the main or secondary audio before recording  
(66, Bilingual Audio Selection)  
M 1  
Hello  
However in the following cases, select whether to record  
the main or secondary audio:  
The selected  
audio only is  
recorded.  
–Recording sound in LPCM (66, Audio Mode for XP  
Recording)  
–“Rec for High Speed Copy” is set to “On” (The default  
setting is “On”. 65)  
If you record from external equipment  
–Select “M 1” or “M 2” on the external equipment.  
M 2  
M 1  
If you record from external  
equipment  
Hello  
Hallo  
–Select both “M 1” and “M 2” on the  
external equipment.  
[HDD] [RAM] [-R] [-RW‹V›]  
[+R] [+RW]  
About the aspect  
when recording a  
programme  
If “Aspect for Recording” in the Setup menu is set to  
“Automatic” (The default setting is “Automatic” 65), the  
programme will be recorded in the original aspect used  
when recording started (including when recording started  
at a commercial, etc.). If recorded with a different aspect,  
select the correct aspect (“16:9” or “4:3”).  
Recorded in 4:3 aspect  
However, in the following case, programme will be  
recorded in 4:3.  
[-R] [-RW‹V›]  
Programme recorded using “EP” or “FR (recordings 5  
hours or longer)” recording modes will be recorded in 4:3  
aspect.  
Set “Rec for High Speed Copy” to “On” before recording to the HDD (The default setting is “On”. 65).  
You can copy titles in high speed mode (max. speed is 75X§); however, the audio and aspect settings (above) are  
necessary before recording to the HDD.  
When you want to  
copy titles in high  
speed mode from  
the HDD to DVD-R,  
etc.  
§ Depending on the disc, max. speed may vary.  
Record to the HDD  
High speed copy to DVD-R, etc.  
HDD  
It is not possible to record the broadcasts that allow “One time only recording” onto DVD-R, DVD-RW, +R, +RW or  
8 cm DVD-RAM discs. Use the HDD or CPRM (84) compatible DVD-RAM.  
When recording  
the “One time only  
recording”  
[RAM] CPRM compatible discs only.  
broadcasts  
[-R] [-RW‹V›] [+R] [+RW]  
[HDD]  
`
(: Can do, –: Cannot do)  
“One time only recording” titles can only be transferred from the HDD to CPRM compatible DVD-RAM (They are  
deleted from the HDD). They cannot be copied.  
Even when copying to videotape the title may not be copied correctly because of the copy guard.  
You cannot copy a playlist created from “One time only recording” titles.  
[-R] [-R]DL] [-RW‹V›] [+R] [+R]DL]  
Playing the disc  
on other DVD  
players  
The disc must be finalised after recording or copying (62).  
It is necessary to finalise DVD-R, etc. on this unit after recording or copying titles to them. You can then play them as a  
commercially sold DVD-Video. However, the discs become play-only and you can no longer record or copy.§  
§You can record and copy again if you format DVD-RW.  
Play on other DVD equipment  
Record to DVD-R, etc.  
Í
/I  
Í
D
O
U
B
L
E
R
E
-
M
A
S
T
E
R
C
D
S
E
Q
U
E
N
T
I
A
L
DISC  
1
2
3
4
5
;
1
:/6  
5/9  
D
I
S
C
E
X
C
H
A
N
G
E
D
I
S
C
S
K
I
P
<OPEN/CLOSE  
H
RC  
SEA  
R
ENTE  
V
O
L
Y
PLA  
DIS  
U
MEN  
OP  
T
URN  
RET  
NU  
ME  
O
N
OFF  
DC  
IN  
9V  
Finalise  
EN  
OP  
D
UN  
RO  
UR  
A.S  
E
EP  
EA  
T
R
MOD  
ITOR  
PIC  
MON  
E
M
ODE  
TUR  
Recording to DVD- You cannot directly record to a DVD-R DL and +R DL disc on this unit.  
R DL and +R DL  
RQT8859  
Record to the HDD and then copy to the disc.  
It is not possible to record to both HDD (Hard Disk Drive) and DVD drive simultaneously.  
8
HDD (Hard disk drive) handling care  
The HDD is a high precision recording instrument and because of its long recording capability and high speed operation it is a very special device  
that is easily susceptible to damage.  
As a basic rule, save important content to a disc as backup.  
The HDD is a device that is not built to withstand vibration/shock or dust  
Depending on the setup environment and handling of the HDD some content may become damaged and play and recording may no longer be  
possible. Especially during operation, do not subject the unit to any vibration, shock, or remove the AC mains lead from the household mains  
socket. In the event of a power failure during recording or play, the content may be damaged.  
e
r
The HDD is a temporary storage device  
a
The HDD is not an everlasting storage device for recorded content. Use the HDD as a temporary storage place for one-off viewing, editing, or  
saving recorded content to a disc.  
Immediately save (backup) all content as soon as you feel there may be a problem with the HDD  
If there is an irregularity within the HDD, repetitive strange sounds or problems with picture (block noise, etc.) may result. Using the HDD in this  
condition may worsen the problem and in the worst case the HDD may no longer be usable. As soon as you notice this type of problem, copy all  
content to disc and request service. Recorded content (data) on a HDD that has become unusable is unrecoverable.  
dlingc  
a
h
)
e
iv  
When the HDD has been automatically entered energy save mode (below), or the unit is turned on or off, there may be an unexpected sound.  
r
d
This does not indicate a problem with this unit.  
k
dis  
Setup precautions  
Cigarette smoke etc. causes malfunction or  
r
Do not place in an enclosed area where the rear cooling fan  
and the cooling vents on the side are covered up.  
Place the unit on a surface that is flat and not subject to  
vibration or impact.  
breakdown  
The unit may breakdown if cigarette smoke or bug spray/vapor,  
etc. gets inside the unit.  
D(Ha  
While operating  
Do not place on anything that generates  
heat like a video cassette recorder, etc.  
Do not place in an area often subject to  
DO NOT  
Do not move the unit or subject to vibration or impact. (The  
HDD may become damaged.)  
ing/HD  
d
r
temperature changes.  
Do not remove the AC mains lead from the household mains  
socket, or flip the power breaker switch.  
While the unit is on, the HDD is rotating at high speed. Sound or  
movement due to rotation is normal.  
o
c
This unit  
VCR  
Place in an area where condensation does  
not occur. Condensation is a phenomenon  
where moisture forms on a cold surface  
when there is an extreme change in  
temperature. Condensation may cause internal damage to the  
unit.  
e
r
r
o
f
s
e
When moving the unit  
1 Turn the unit off. (Wait until “BYE” disappears from the  
display.)  
Conditions where condensation may occur  
–When there is an extreme change in temperature (moving from  
a very hot location to a very cold location, or vice versa, or  
when subjected to an air conditioner or when cooled air  
directly impacts the unit). When the HDD (warms during  
operation) is subjected to cold air, condensation may form on  
the inside of the HDD and may cause damage to the HDD  
heads, etc.  
2 Remove the AC mains lead from the household mains socket.  
3 Move only after the unit has come to a complete stop (approx.  
2 minutes) in order to avoid subjecting to vibration and shock.  
(Even after turning the unit off, the HDD continues operating  
for a short time.)  
not  
ta  
Impor  
–When there is high humidity or a lot of steam in the room.  
–During the rainy season.  
In the above situation, without turning the unit on, let the unit  
adjust to the room temperature and wait 2–3 hours until  
condensation is gone.  
HDD recording time remaining  
This unit records using a VBR (Variable bit rate) data compression system to vary recorded data segments to match video data segments which  
may cause differences in the displayed amount of time and space remaining for recording.  
If the remaining amount of time is insufficient, delete any unwanted titles to create enough space before you start recording. (Deleting a playlist  
will not increase the amount of time.)  
The HDD automatically enters energy save mode  
The HDD has been automatically entered energy save mode. (The HDD continues to rotate at high speed while the unit is on. In order to extend  
the life of the HDD, the HDD will be entered energy save mode if no operation has been performed for 30 minutes while there is no disc on the  
disc tray.)  
While in energy save mode play or recording may not start right away because the HDD takes time to be re-activated.  
When not using the unit, we recommend removing the disc in the tray in order to set the HDD to the energy save mode.  
Indemnity concerning recorded content  
Panasonic does not accept any responsibility for damages directly or indirectly due to any type of problems that result in loss of recording or  
edited content (data), and does not guarantee any content if recording or editing does not work properly. Likewise, the above also applies in a  
case where any type of repair is made to the unit (including any other non-HDD related component).  
RQT8859  
9
Disc and card handling  
How to hold a disc or card  
Handling precautions  
Do not touch the recorded surface or the terminal surface.  
Do not attach labels or stickers to discs. (This may cause disc  
warping and un-balanced rotation, rendering it unusable.)  
Write on the label side of the disc only with a soft, oil-based felt  
pen. Do not use ballpoint pens or other hard writing implements.  
Do not use record cleaning sprays, benzine, thinner, static  
electricity prevention liquids or any other solvent.  
Do not use scratch-proof protectors or covers.  
Do not expose the terminals of the card to water, garbage or other  
strange things.  
DO  
DO NOT  
Concerning non-cartridge discs  
Be careful about scratches and dirt.  
Do not drop stack, or impact discs. Do not place objects on them.  
Do not use the following discs:  
If there is dirt or condensation on the disc  
–Discs with exposed adhesive from removed stickers or labels  
(rental discs, etc.).  
Wipe with a damp cloth and then wipe dry.  
–Discs that are badly warped or cracked.  
–Irregularly shaped discs, such as heart  
DO  
DO NOT  
DO NOT  
shapes.  
Do not place in the following areas:  
–In direct sunlight.  
–In very dusty or humid areas.  
–Near a heater.  
–Locations susceptible to significant difference in temperature  
(condensation can occur).  
–Where static electricity or electromagnetic waves occur.  
To protect discs from scratches and dirt, return them to their cases  
or cartridges when you are not using them.  
The manufacturer accepts no responsibility and offers no compensation for loss of recorded or edited material due to a problem  
with the unit or recordable media, and accepts no responsibility and offers no compensation for any subsequent damage caused by  
such loss.  
Examples of causes of such losses are  
A disc recorded and edited with this unit is played in a DVD Recorder or computer disc drive manufactured by another company.  
A disc used as described above and then played again in this unit.  
A disc recorded and edited with a DVD Recorder or computer disc drive manufactured by another company is played in this unit.  
Unit care  
The precision parts in this unit are readily affected by the  
DO NOT  
environment, especially temperature, humidity, and dust.  
Cigarette smoke also can cause malfunction or breakdown.  
Do not place the unit on  
amplifiers or equipment  
that may become hot.  
The heat can damage the unit.  
To clean this unit, wipe with a soft, dry cloth.  
Never use alcohol, paint thinner or benzine to clean this unit.  
Before using chemically treated cloth, carefully read the  
instructions that came with the cloth.  
Observe the following points to ensure continued listening and  
viewing pleasure.  
Dust and dirt may adhere to the unit’s lens over time, making it  
[Note]  
Do not obstruct the rear panel’s internal cooling fan.  
impossible to record or play discs.  
Use the DVD lens cleaner about once every year, depending on  
frequency of use and the operating environment. Carefully read the  
lens cleaner’s instructions before use.  
Before moving the unit, ensure the disc tray is empty.  
Failure to do so will risk severely damaging the disc and the  
unit.  
DVD lens cleaner: RP-CL720E  
This lens cleaner may not be for sale depending on the  
region.  
RQT8859  
10  
Included accessories  
Please check and identify the supplied accessories.  
(Product numbers correct as of May 2007. These may be subject to change.)  
ion  
(N2QAYB000135)  
rmat  
1
Remote control  
1
AC mains lead  
2
RF coaxial cables  
2
Batteries  
for remote control  
1
Audio/video  
cable  
o
For use with this unit only. Do not  
use it with other equipment.  
Also, do not use cords for other  
equipment with this unit.  
inf  
l
o
r
cont  
e
mot  
Thre  
/
The remote control information  
ies  
r
o
Batteries  
Use  
es  
Insert so the poles (i and j) match those in the remote control.  
When closing the lid, insert it from the j (minus) side.  
c
c
Remote control signal sensor  
a
d
e
d
u
l
/Inc  
e
r
a
20  
20  
30  
30  
R6/LR6, AA  
Do not use rechargeable type batteries.  
Do not mix old and new batteries.  
Do not use different types at the same time.  
Do not heat or expose to flame.  
Do not take apart or short circuit.  
Do not attempt to recharge alkaline or manganese batteries.  
Do not use batteries if the covering has been peeled off.  
dlg/Unitc  
7 m directly in front of the unit  
dha  
r
a
c
d
n
a
c
s
Mishandling of batteries can cause electrolyte leakage which can  
damage items the fluid contacts and may cause a fire.  
Di  
Remove if the remote control is not going to be used for a long  
period of time. Store in a cool, dark place.  
Remote control operations (12)  
RQT8859  
11  
Control reference guide  
Remote control  
Instructions for operations are generally described using the remote control.  
1 Turn the unit on (20)  
2 Select drive (HDD, DVD or SD) (24, 34, 40)  
Drive changes each time you press [DRIVE SELECT].  
3 Select channels and title numbers, etc./Enter numbers  
4 To delete unnecessary recorded titles or still pictures (50)  
5 Basic operations for recording and play  
6 Show digital channel information (23)/Programme information  
within TV Guide screen (29)/Status messages (43)  
7 Selection/OK, Frame-by-frame (36)  
8 Show Top Menu/DIRECT NAVIGATOR (34, 35, 44)  
9 Show OPTION menu (44)  
>
DVD  
TV  
1
Í
Í
?
@
VOL  
CH  
DRIVE  
SELECT  
AV  
2
3
This menu is used when playing or editing titles and still pictures,  
etc.  
PAGE  
CH  
2 3  
1
: Select audio (Analogue broadcast only) (36)  
; Use Colour buttons according to on-screen instructions.  
“Red” button for System update (23)/TV Guide screen  
(29)/Timer Recording screen (32)/DIRECT NAVIGATOR  
(34)/Edit Favourites screen (69)/Analogue Manual Tuning  
screen (71)  
4 5 6  
ANALOGUE  
CH  
8 9  
7
A
B
C
G-Code  
DELETE  
INPUT  
0
SELECT  
4
5
“Green” button for TV Guide screen (29)/  
DIRECT NAVIGATOR (40)/Edit Favourites screen (69)  
Yellow” button for TV Guide screen (29)/Edit Favourites  
screen (69)  
SKIP  
SLOW/SEARCH  
“Blue” button for digital channel information (23)/TV Guide  
screen (29)/Timer Recording screen (31)/Edit Favourites  
screen (69)  
PAUSE  
PLAY/x1.3  
EXIT  
STOP  
STATUS  
D
E
6
7
< Show on-screen menu (42)  
I
Menu for disc playback and switching audio (Digital broadcast)  
etc.  
= Recording functions  
8
F
[¥ REC] Start recording (24)  
OK  
[REC MODE] Change recording mode (24)  
> Transmit the remote control signal  
? Television operations (21)  
@ Channel select/Change pages in the TV Guide system (24, 29)  
A Select analogue channel (23)  
B Input select (AV1, AV2, AV3, AV4 or DV) (58)  
C Show G-CODE screen (30)  
D Exit the menu screen  
E Show the TV Guide screen (28)  
F Show FUNCTION MENU window (63)  
By using the FUNCTION MENU window you may access the  
main functions (Playback, Recording, etc.) quickly and easily.  
G Return to previous screen  
9
OPTION  
RETURN  
G
H
CREATE  
:
;
<
=
DISPLAY  
AUDIO  
REC  
CHAPTER  
MANUAL SKIP  
I
REC MODE TIME SLIP PROG/CHECK  
J
K
H Create chapter (36)  
I Skip approx. 30 seconds forward (36)  
J Show Timer Recording screen (31)  
K Skip the specified time (36)  
RQT8859  
12  
Main unit  
1
3
4
6
2
5
OPEN/CLOSE  
REC  
guide  
e
nc  
8 9  
<
7
:
;
e
r
Opening the front panel  
REC  
e
f
Place your finger on the protruding section below the 4 and  
e
press down to flip open the front panel.  
r
l
o
1 Standby/on switch (Í/I) (20)  
8 Stop (24, 35)  
9 Start play (34)  
: Start recording (24)/Specify a time to stop recording (26)  
; Open/close disc tray (24, 34)  
Contr  
Press to switch the unit from on to standby mode or vice versa. In  
standby mode, the unit is still consuming a small amount of power.  
2 Disc tray (24, 34)  
3 Connection for digital video (DV) camcorder (58)  
4 SD Card slot (below)  
< Remote control signal sensor  
5 Connection for VCR, camcorder etc. (58)  
6 Display (below)  
Rear panel terminals (14–17)  
7 Channel select (23, 24)  
Inserting, Removing the SD Card  
When the card indicator (“SD”) on the unit’s display is flashing, the card is being read from or written to. Do not turn off the unit or remove the card.  
Such action may result in malfunction or loss of the card’s contents.  
Inserting foreign objects can cause a malfunction.  
You can use SD Cards with capacities from 8 MB to 4 GB (7).  
Inserting the card  
Removing the card  
Press on the centre of  
the card.  
1
2
Press on the centre of the  
card until it clicks into  
place.  
If you are using a  
miniSD card, insert it  
into the miniSD card  
adaptor that comes  
with the card.  
Pull it straight out.  
ADAPTER  
Insert and remove this  
adaptor from the unit.  
Insert the card label up with  
the cut-off corner on the right.  
Automatic drive select function  
If you insert an SD Card while the unit is stopped, the “SD Card” screen is displayed. Select an item and press [OK] to switch to the SD drive  
(40, 56).  
If you remove an SD Card, the HDD drive is automatically selected.  
The unit’s display  
1
2
4
3
REC  
5
6
PLAY  
8
9
7
1 Digital broadcast indicator  
Lights when the unit is receiving digital broadcast or TV Guide data.  
2 Copying indicator  
Lights during copy.  
3
Recording  
indicator  
Playback  
indicator  
Recording/  
Playback indicator  
REC  
REC  
PLAY  
PLAY  
4 Timer recording indicator  
5 SD Card slot indicator  
6 Disc indicator  
7 Drive (HDD, DVD or SD) indicator  
Lights when the HDD, DVD or SD drive is selected.  
8 Main display section indicator  
Lights when a disc that is supported by this unit is inserted in the  
tray.  
9 Recording mode indicator  
RQT8859  
13  
STEP 1 Connection  
Make sure to use the pair of supplied RF coaxial cables  
Use the pair of supplied RF coaxial cables only when you make connections to the unit through its RF IN and RF OUT terminals. Striping may  
appear and disrupt images on the TV if you use different cables for connection.  
Before connection, turn off all equipment and read the appropriate operating instructions.  
Select the connection pattern that matches your environment from pattern A–B. Confirm connections not listed below with your  
dealer.  
When the unit is not to be used for a long time  
To save power, unplug it from the household mains socket. This unit consumes a small amount of power, even when it is turned off  
[approx. 2 W (Power Save mode)]  
When “Power Save” is set to “On”, the “Quick Start” function does not work.  
Connecting to a television with 21-pin Scart terminal  
You can also connect with the AV1 terminal on this unit using the 21-pin Scart cable.  
If your television is equipped with RGB input capability, by connecting with a fully wired 21-pin Scart cable you can see video using RGB  
output on this unit.  
[Required]setting]  
AV1 Output” in the Setup menu (67)  
Connecting to a VCR with 21-pin Scart terminal  
You can also connect with the AV2 terminal on this unit using the 21-pin Scart cable.  
[Required]setting]  
“AV2 Input” in the Setup menu (67)  
Connecting a television  
A
To the aerial  
Aerial  
cable  
Television’s rear panel  
AUDIO IN VIDEO IN  
VHF/UHF  
RF IN  
R
L
To household mains socket  
(AC 220 to 240 V, 50 Hz)  
Red White Yellow  
RF coaxial cable  
(included)  
4
1
2
Other connections  
(16, 17)  
3
AC mains lead  
(included)  
Connect only after all other  
connections are complete.  
Audio/Video cable  
(included)  
Cooling fan  
RF  
IN  
Y
Red White Yellow  
PB  
AV1  
(
TV  
)
PR  
RF  
OUT  
OPTICAL  
AC IN  
DIGITAL AUDIO OUT COMPONENT  
(PCM/BITSTREAM)  
VIDEO OUT  
RF coaxial  
cable  
(included)  
AV OUT  
R-AUDIO-L  
VIDEO  
S VIDEO  
(
)
AV2 EXT  
This unit’s rear panel  
RQT8859  
14  
Connecting a television and VCR  
B
DO NOT  
Connect the unit directly to the television  
If you connect the unit through an AV selector or video cassette recorder to the television,  
video signal will be affected by copyright protection systems and the picture may not be  
shown correctly.  
Television  
When connecting to a television with a built-in VCR  
Connect to the input terminals on the television side if there are both television and  
VCR input terminals.  
VCR  
ion  
t
c
This unit  
one  
C
Connecting an Analogue television and VCR  
1
P
To the aerial  
Aerial cable  
Analogue television’s rear panel  
To household mains socket  
(AC 220 to 240 V, 50 Hz)  
AUDIO IN VIDEO IN  
R
L
VHF/UHF  
RF IN  
STE  
Red White Yellow  
6
AC mains lead  
(included)  
Connect only after all other  
connections are complete.  
Other connections  
(16, 17)  
5
1
Audio/Video cable  
(included)  
RF  
coaxial  
cable  
(included)  
Cooling fan  
RF  
IN  
Y
Red White Yellow  
PB  
AV1  
(
TV  
)
PR  
RF  
OUT  
OPTICAL  
AC IN  
DIGITAL AUDIO OUT COMPONENT  
(PCM/BITSTREAM)  
VIDEO OUT  
AV OUT  
R-AUDIO-L  
VIDEO  
S VIDEO  
(
)
AV2 EXT  
Red White Yellow  
This unit’s rear panel  
4
2
Audio/Video cable  
RF coaxial cable  
3
RF coaxial cable  
(included)  
Red White Yellow  
VCR’s rear panel  
RF OUT  
VHF/UHF  
RF IN  
R
L
VIDEO OUT  
AUDIO OUT  
Connecting a Digital television and VCR  
To the aerial  
To household mains socket  
(AC 220 to 240 V, 50 Hz)  
Aerial cable  
Digital television’s rear panel  
AUDIO IN VIDEO IN  
Splitter  
R
L
VHF/UHF  
RF IN  
Red White Yellow  
6
4
AC mains lead  
(included)  
Connect only after all other  
connections are complete.  
Other connections  
(16, 17)  
1
5
Audio/Video cable  
RF coaxial cable  
(included)  
(included)  
Cooling fan  
RF  
IN  
Red White Yellow  
Y
PB  
AV1  
(
TV  
)
PR  
RF  
OUT  
OPTICAL  
AC IN  
DIGITAL AUDIO OUT COMPONENT  
(PCM/BITSTREAM)  
VIDEO OUT  
AV OUT  
R-AUDIO-L  
VIDEO  
S VIDEO  
(
)
AV2 EXT  
Red White Yellow  
This unit’s rear panel  
2
Audio/Video cable  
RF coaxial cable  
(included)  
3
Red White Yellow  
RQT8859  
VHF/UHF  
RF IN  
R
L
VIDEO OUT  
VCR’s rear panel  
AUDIO OUT  
15  
STEP 1 Connection  
Other connections  
Leave “Yellow” unconnected.  
§
Connecting a television with COMPONENT VIDEO  
terminals  
Connecting a television with S VIDEO terminals  
The S VIDEO OUT terminal achieves a more vivid picture than the  
VIDEO OUT terminal. (Actual results depend on the television.)  
Television’s rear panel  
AUDIO IN  
Y
Television’s rear panel  
COMPONENT  
VIDEO IN  
R
L
PB  
PR  
AUDIO IN VIDEO S VIDEO  
R
L
IN  
IN  
Red White  
Red White  
Component  
Video cable  
§
Audio/Video  
cable  
(included)  
§
§
S Video  
cable  
RF  
IN  
Red White  
Y
Audio/Video cable  
(included)  
PB  
AV1  
(
)
TV  
§
PR  
RF  
OUT  
OPTICAL  
DIGITAL AUDIO OUT COMPONENT  
(PCM/BITTSTREAM)  
VIDEO OUT  
R-AUDIO-L  
VIDEO  
S VIDEO  
(
)
AV2 EXT  
This unit’s rear panel  
Red White  
COMPONENT VIDEO terminals can be used for either interlace or  
progressive output (85) and provide a purer picture than the  
S VIDEO OUT terminal.  
Connect to terminals of the same colour.  
If you have a regular television (CRT: cathode ray tube)  
Use component output with progressive “Off” (The default setting  
67), even if it is progressive compatible, because progressive  
output can cause some flickering. This is the same for multi system  
televisions using PAL mode.  
AV OUT  
R-AUDIO-L  
VIDEO  
S VIDEO  
This unit’s rear panel  
CRT  
DO NOT  
COMPONENT  
VIDEO OUT  
Progressive output  
COMPONENT  
VIDEO IN  
This unit  
For progressive output (21)  
Connecting an amplifier or system component  
Connecting an amplifier with a digital input  
Connecting a stereo amplifier  
terminal  
To enjoy multi-channel surround sound DVD-Video, connect an  
amplifier with Dolby Digital, DTS and MPEG decoders.  
[Required]setting]  
Amplifier’s rear panel  
“Digital Audio Output” in the Setup menu (66)  
When this unit is connected to an amplifier with an Optical digital  
audio cable and connected to a television with an HDMI cable, you  
can enjoy the highest quality of audio from the disc by setting  
“Digital Audio Output” to “Optical Only” in the Setup menu (67).  
In this case audio is only output from the amplifier not the  
television.  
AUDIO IN  
R
L
Red White  
Before purchasing an optical digital audio cable (not included),  
check the terminal shape of the connected equipment.  
You cannot use DTS Digital Surround decoders not suited to DVD.  
Audio cable  
Amplifier’s  
rear panel  
OPTICAL IN  
Red White  
Optical digital  
audio cable  
Do not bend  
Insert fully, with this  
side facing up.  
sharply when  
connecting.  
R-AUDIO-L  
VIDEO  
S VIDEO  
Y
PB  
This unit’s rear panel  
AV1  
(
)
TV  
PR  
OPTICAL  
DIGITAL AUDIO OUT COMPONENT  
(PCM/BITSTREAM)  
VIDEO OUT  
(
)
AV2 EXT  
This unit’s rear panel  
RQT8859  
16  
Connecting with an HDMI (High Definition Multimedia Interface) terminal  
When connected to an HDMI compatible unit, an uncompressed digital audio and video signal is transmitted. You can enjoy high quality, digital  
video and audio with just one cord. When connecting to an HDMI-compatible HDTV (High Definition Television), this unit’s output can be switched  
to 1080p, 1080i or 720p HD video.  
Please use the HDMI cables 5.0 meters or less.  
Preparation  
From the Setup menu (67), set “Digital Audio Output” to “HDMI and Optical”.  
ion  
t
c
Connecting to a TV  
Connecting to a receiver  
one  
Television’s  
rear panel  
Television’s  
rear panel  
C
HDMI IN  
HDMI IN  
1
P
STE  
This unit’s  
rear panel  
Receiver’s rear  
panel  
HDMI OUT  
HDMI IN  
HDMI AV OUT  
AV OUT  
R-AUDIO-L  
VIDEO  
S
VIDEO  
This unit’s  
rear panel  
If you are connecting to a TV that is only compatible with 2 channel  
audio output, audio with 3 channels or more will be down mixed  
(84) and output as 2 channels, even if connecting with an HDMI  
cable. (Some discs cannot be down mixed.)  
HDMI AV OUT  
AV OUT  
VIDEO  
S
VIDEO  
You cannot connect this unit to DVI devices that are incompatible  
with HDCP.  
For units compatible with HDCP (High-Bandwidth Digital Content  
Protection) copyright protection that are equipped with a digital DVI  
input terminal (PC monitors, etc.):  
Depending on the unit, images may not display properly or at all  
when connecting with a DVI/HDMI switching cable. (Audio cannot  
be output.)  
RQT8859  
17  
STEP 1 Connection  
VIERA Link “HDAVI Control TM”  
What is VIERA Link “HDAVI Control”?  
VIERA Link “HDAVI Control” is a convenient function that offers linked operations of this unit, and a Panasonic TV (VIERA) or  
receiver under “HDAVI Control”. You can use this function by connecting the equipment with the HDMI cable. See the operating  
instructions for connected equipment for operational details.  
VIERA Link “HDAVI Control”, based on the control functions provided by HDMI which is an industry standard known as HDMI CEC  
(Consumer Electronics Control), is a unique function that we have developed and added. As such, its operation with other manufacturers’  
equipment that supports HDMI CEC cannot be guaranteed.  
This unit supports “HDAVI Control 2” function.  
“HDAVI Control 2” is the newest standard (current as of February, 2007) for Panasonic’s HDAVI Control compatible equipment. This standard  
is compatible with Panasonic’s conventional HDAVI equipment.  
It is recommended that you use Panasonic’s HDMI cable.  
Recommended part number: RP-CDHG15 (1.5 m), RP-CDHG30 (3.0 m), RP-CDHG50 (5.0 m), etc.  
Non-HDMI-compliant cables cannot be utilised.  
Preparation  
1. Connect this unit to your TV or receiver with an HDMI cable (17).  
2. Set “VIERA Link” to “On” (67). (The default setting is “On”.)  
3. Set the “HDAVI Control” operations on the connected equipment (e.g., TV).  
4. Turn on all “HDAVI Control” compatible equipment, turn the TV off/on, and then select this unit’s input channel on the connected TV so that the  
“HDAVI Control” function works properly.  
Also when the connection or settings are changed, repeat this procedure.  
What you can do with “HDAVI Control”  
(When the TV is on)  
When the TV is on and the following operations are performed, the TV’s input will automatically switch to HDMI input  
mode and the TV displays the corresponding action.  
(Picture or sound may not be available for the first few seconds.)  
Easy playback  
Press [FUNCTION MENU]§1, [1] (PLAY)§2, [DIRECT NAVIGATOR], [GUIDE], [G-Code], [PROG/CHECK] etc.  
(When the TV is off)  
When the TV is off and the following operations are performed, the TV will automatically turn on and displays the  
corresponding action.  
(Picture or sound may not be available for the first few seconds.)  
Power on link  
Press [FUNCTION MENU]§1, [1] (PLAY)§2, [DIRECT NAVIGATOR], [GUIDE], [G-Code], [PROG/CHECK] etc.  
[DVD-V] [CD] [VCD] and MP3  
The TV is automatically turned on when you insert the discs.  
When you set the TV to standby mode, the unit is also automatically set to standby mode. The unit is automatically  
set to standby mode even if the FUNCTION MENU screen etc. is displayed during playback or when the unit set to a  
Power off link  
timer recording.  
Even if the TV is set to standby mode, the unit will not be set to standby mode at the same time when recording,  
copying, finalising etc.  
When this unit is connected to an “HDAVI Control” compatible Panasonic receiver with an HDMI cable, the receiver  
will also turn off.  
§1 This button is available only when this unit is on.  
§2 When this button is pressed, the playback image is not immediately displayed on the screen and it may not be possible to watch the contents  
from where playback started.  
In this case, press [:] or [6] to go back to where playback started.  
[Note]  
These functions may not work normally depending on the equipment condition.  
About “HDAVI Control” function, read the manual of the connected equipment (e.g., TV) too.  
RQT8859  
18  
Easy control only with VIERA remote control  
If you connect this unit to the TV that has “HDAVI Control 2” function with an HDMI cable, you can enjoy using more convenient functions.  
You can operate this unit using the following buttons on the TV remote control.  
[3, 4, 2, 1], [OK], [RETURN], [EXIT], [OPTION] and the coloured buttons.  
Use the remote control for this unit to operate any other buttons (numbered buttons, etc.) that are not listed above.  
Refer to the TV operating instructions for operating the TV.  
Using the FUNCTION  
ion  
1 Display this unit’s “FUNCTION MENU” window using the TV remote control.  
t
c
MENU window to  
If this unit is set to standby mode, it will automatically turn on.  
operate this unit  
one  
C
1
P
2 Select the item you want to operate with the TV  
FUNCTION MENU  
HDD  
Remain 70:00 SP  
remote control, and press [OK].  
Playback  
STE  
Recording  
Delete  
Copy  
To Others  
OK  
RETURN  
About the FUNCTION MENU  
window (63).  
By using the TV remote control, you can play discs using the “Control Panel” (below) and display the Top  
Menu for DVD-Video.  
Using the OPTION  
menu window to  
operate this unit  
Control Panel  
Control Panel is  
displayed (below).  
1 Press [OPTION].  
e,g.,  
FUNCTION MENU FUNCTION MENU  
window is displayed  
Control Panel  
FUNCTION MENU  
Top Menu  
(above).  
Menu  
Top Menu [DVD-V]  
Menu [DVD-V]  
Top menu is displayed  
(35).  
Drive Select  
OK  
RETURN  
Menu is displayed  
(35).  
[Note]  
Drive Select  
Select the HDD, DVD or  
SD drive  
You cannot use the OPTION menu while the Top Menu  
for DVD-Video is displayed and while DVD-Video is  
copying.  
Rotate RIGHT  
(JPEG)  
Rotate the still picture  
(41).  
2 Select an item then press [OK].  
Rotate LEFT  
(JPEG)  
Zoom in (JPEG)  
Zoom out (JPEG)  
Enlarge or shrink the still  
picture (41).  
Using the “Control Panel”, you can operate search backward, search forward, stop, etc, with the TV remote  
control.  
Perform steps 1 and 2 of “Using the OPTION menu window to operate this unit” (above).  
Using the Control  
Panel  
The Control Panel is displayed (right).  
When playing a title or DVD-Video, etc.  
Control Panel  
Pause  
Stop  
–[3]: Pause, [4]: Stop, [2]: Search backward, [1]: Search forward, [OK]:  
Play, [EXIT]: Exit the screen.  
While playing still pictures  
–[4]: Stop, [2]: View previous picture, [1]: View next picture, [EXIT]: Exit  
the screen.  
Exit  
Search  
Play  
Search  
When you want to leave the TV on and set only this unit to standby mode  
Press [Í DVD] on this unit’s remote control and set to standby mode.  
When not using “HDAVI Control”  
Set “VIERA Link” in the Setup menu to “Off” (67).  
RQT8859  
19  
STEP 2 Channel reception settings and TV aspect settings  
3 Press [3, 4] to select your area and  
Í/ l  
press [OK].  
TV Aspect  
REC  
OPEN/CLOSE  
16:9 WIDE TV  
4:3 TV  
16:9  
Pan & Scan  
Letterbox  
DVD  
TV  
SELECT  
Í DVD  
Í
Í
OK  
VOL  
CH  
RETURN  
DRIVE  
SELECT  
AV  
PAGE  
CH  
2 3  
4 5 6  
1
4 Press [3, 4] to select the TV aspect  
Numbered  
buttons  
and press [OK].  
ANALOGUE  
CH  
8 9  
7
16:9:  
When connected to a 16:9 widescreen  
television.  
G-Code  
DELETE  
INPUT  
0
SELECT  
SKIP  
SLOW/SEARCH  
Pan & Scan: When connected to a 4:3 aspect television,  
side picture is trimmed for 16:9 picture (85).  
PAUSE  
PLAY/x1.3  
EXIT  
STOP  
STATUS  
I
Letterbox: When connected to a 4:3 aspect television.  
16:9 picture is shown in the letterbox style  
(85).  
OK  
3,4,2,1  
OPTION  
RETURN  
OK  
RETURN  
CREATE  
DISPLAY  
CHAPTER  
AUDIO  
REC  
MANUAL SKIP  
REC MODE TIME SLIP PROG/CHECK  
To stop partway  
Press [RETURN].  
1 Turn on the television and select the  
When clock setting screen is displayed  
appropriate AV input to suit the  
connections to this unit.  
In step 2, if the clock setting screen appears on the television, set  
the clock manually.  
This is a 24-hour clock.  
Clock  
2 Press [Í DVD] to turn the unit on.  
DVB Auto-Setup starts. The unit will search for the terrestrial  
digital channels.  
Time  
0
Date  
1
:
00  
:
00  
.
1
.
2007  
This takes about 5 minutes.  
Terrestrial digital channels are stored into logical channels  
numbers.  
Analogue channels are preset at the time of shipping. If you  
would like to add new TV channels, set them manually  
(71).  
Number  
0
9
Please set the clock.  
OK: access RETURN: leave  
CHANGE  
OK  
SELECT  
RETURN  
1
2
Press [2, 1] to select the item you want to change and press  
[3, 4] to change the setting.  
The items change as follows:  
Hour!#Minute!#Second!#Day!#Month!#Year  
^-----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------J  
You can also use the numbered buttons for setting.  
Press [OK] when you have finished the settings.  
DVB Auto-Setup  
Please wait!  
Ch 6  
69  
Prog. Channel Service Name  
Net ID TS ID Quality  
352  
354  
ABC  
ABC 2  
12289  
12302  
12302 12289  
9
9
1
2
RETURN: to cancel  
TV aspect setting screen (above) appears.  
RETURN  
(Go to step 4)  
DVB Auto-Setup is complete when Time Zone setting screen  
appears.  
To confirm that stations have been tuned  
correctly (69)  
The time information for your region can be obtained.  
Time Zone  
To restart set up (72)  
NSW / ACT  
Victoria  
Queensland  
South Australia  
Western Australia  
Northern Territory  
SELECT  
Tasmania  
OK  
RETURN  
If the clock setting screen is displayed (right).  
RQT8859  
20  
STEP 3 Set up to match your television and remote control  
4 Press [3, 4] to select “Connection”  
and press [1].  
DVD  
TV  
Setup  
Í
TV Aspect  
16:9  
Off  
PAL  
Í
TV operation  
buttons  
Progressive  
TV System  
HDMI Settings  
AV1 Output  
AV2 Input  
VOL  
CH  
DRIVE  
SELECT  
AV  
Tuning  
Disc  
PAGE  
CH  
l
Video  
Video  
o
r
Picture  
Sound  
Display  
2 3  
1
Numbered  
buttons  
4 5 6  
TAB  
RETURN  
SELECT  
OK  
ont  
Connection  
Others  
ANALOGUE  
CH  
c
8 9  
0
7
G-Code  
DELETE  
INPUT  
ote  
SELECT  
SKIP  
SLOW/SEARCH  
5 Press [3, 4] to select “Progressive”  
m
e
r
and press [OK].  
d
n
PAUSE  
PLAY/x1.3  
EXIT  
STOP  
Setup  
Progressive  
STATUS  
On  
Off  
EXIT  
I
ona  
i
Tuning  
s
i
Disc  
v
FUNCTION  
MENU  
Picture  
Sound  
Display  
OK  
le  
3,4,2,1  
SELECT  
OK  
te  
OPTION  
RETURN  
Connection  
Others  
OK  
RETURN  
RETURN  
CREATE  
our  
DISPLAY  
CHAPTER  
AUDIO  
REC  
MANUAL SKIP  
hy  
REC MODE TIME SLIP PROG/CHECK  
6 Press [3, 4] to select “On” and press  
tc  
[OK].  
Output becomes progressive.  
[Note]  
uptoma  
t
When connected to a regular television (CRT: Cathode ray tube) or  
a multi system television using PAL mode, even if it is progressive  
compatible, progressive output can cause some flickering. Turn off  
“Progressive” if this occurs (43).  
e
S
EP3  
Picture will not be displayed correctly if connected to an  
incompatible television.  
To enjoy progressive video  
ST  
/
s
There is no output from the COMPONENT VIDEO OUT terminals if  
“AV1 Output” in the Setup menu is set to “RGB 1 (without  
component)” or “RGB 2 (without component)” (67).  
You can enjoy progressive video by connecting this unit’s  
COMPONENT VIDEO OUT terminals to an LCD/plasma television  
or LCD projector compatible with progressive scan (85).  
ting  
e
s
t
1
While stopped  
To return to the previous screen  
Press [RETURN].  
c
pe  
Press [FUNCTION MENU].  
s
a
To exit the screen  
Press [EXIT].  
FUNCTION MENU  
HDD  
Remain 70:00 SP  
Playback  
Recording  
ndTV  
Delete  
Copy  
a
To Others  
OK  
ings  
RETURN  
t
t
e
Television operation  
You can configure the remote control TV operation buttons to turn  
the television on/off, change the television input mode, select the  
television channel and change the television volume.  
2 Press [3, 4] to select “To Others”  
tions  
p
e
c
e
and press [OK].  
r
l
3 Press [3, 4] to select “Setup” and  
e
press [OK].  
n
DVD  
TV  
Setup  
ha  
Í
Edit Favourites  
Auto-Setup Restart  
Í
Volume  
C
VOL  
CH  
Turn TV on/off  
Input select  
DRIVE  
SELECT  
Settings for Digital Services  
AV  
2
Tuning  
Channel  
Select  
Settings for Analogue Services  
Disc  
PAGE  
CH  
EP  
Picture  
Sound  
Display  
2 3  
1
T
S
SELECT  
TAB  
4 5 6  
Connection  
RETURN  
Others  
1
Point the remote control at the television  
While pressing [Í TV], enter the code  
with the numbered buttons.  
e.g.,  
01:  
[0] [1]  
10:  
[1] [0]  
(continued on the next page)  
RQT8859  
21  
STEP 3 Set up to match your television and remote control  
(continued)  
When other Panasonic products  
Refer to the control reference on page 21.  
respond to this remote control  
Change the remote control code on the main unit and the remote  
control (the two must match) if you place other Panasonic products  
close together.  
Manufacturer and Code No.  
Brand  
Panasonic  
AIWA  
Code  
01/02/03/04  
35  
Brand  
Code  
05/28  
METZ  
MITSUBISHI  
MIVAR  
05/19/20/47  
Use “DVD 1”, the factory set code, under normal circumstances.  
AKAI  
27/30  
24  
36  
33  
BEJING  
BEKO  
33  
NEC  
05/71/72/73/ NOBLEX  
74  
1
While stopped  
Press [FUNCTION MENU].  
BENQ  
58/59  
NOKIA  
25/26/27/  
60/61  
2 Press [3, 4] to select “To Others”  
BP  
09  
NORDMENDE  
OLEVIA  
10  
and press [OK].  
BRANDT  
BUSH  
10/15  
05  
45  
ONWA  
30/39/70  
05  
3 Press [3, 4] to select “Setup” and  
CENTREX  
CHANGHONG  
CURTIS  
DAEWOO  
DESMET  
DUAL  
66  
ORION  
press [OK].  
69  
PEONY  
49/69  
41/48/64  
05/06/46  
05  
05  
PHILCO  
PHILIPS  
PHONOLA  
PIONEER  
PROVIEW  
PYE  
4 Press [3, 4] to select “Others” and  
64/65  
05  
press [1].  
05  
37/38  
52  
5 Press [3, 4] to select “Remote  
ELEMIS  
FERGUSON  
FINLUX  
FISHER  
FUJITSU  
FUNAI  
05  
Control” and press [OK].  
10/34  
61  
05  
RADIOLA  
SABA  
05  
6 Press [3, 4] to select the code (“DVD  
21  
10  
1”, “DVD 2” or “DVD 3”) and press  
[OK].  
53  
SALORA  
SAMSUNG  
26  
63/67  
32/42/43/  
65/68  
Remote Control  
Setup  
GOLDSTAR  
GOODMANS  
GRADIENTE  
GRUNDIG  
05/50/51  
SANSUI  
SANYO  
05  
Press “” and “OK” together  
for more than 5 seconds on the remote  
control.  
05  
36  
09  
21/54/55/56  
05/29/30  
Tuning  
Disc  
Picture  
SCHNEIDER  
SEG  
05/69/75/  
76/77/78  
To change the code on the remote control  
HIKONA  
HITACHI  
52  
SELECO  
05/25  
18  
05/22/23/40/ SHARP  
41  
7 While pressing [OK], press and hold  
the numbered button ([1], [2] or [3]) for  
more than 5 seconds.  
INNO HIT  
IRRADIO  
ITT  
05  
30  
25  
49  
SIEMENS  
SINUDYNE  
SONY  
09  
05  
08  
8 Press [OK].  
JINGXING  
TCL  
31/33/66/  
67/69  
When the following indicator appears on the  
JVC  
17/30/39/70  
TELEFUNKEN  
10/11/12/  
13/14  
unit’s display  
KDS  
52  
TEVION  
52  
The unit’s remote control code  
KOLIN  
KONKA  
LG  
45  
TEX ONDA  
THOMSON  
TOSHIBA  
52  
62  
10/15/44  
16/57  
05  
05/50/51  
07/46  
LOEWE  
WHITE  
Change the code on the remote control to match the main unit’s  
WESTINGHOUSE  
(step 7).  
MAG  
52  
YAMAHA  
18/41  
[Note]  
Executing “Shipping Condition” in the Setup menu returns the main  
unit code to “DVD 1”. Change the remote control code to 1  
(step 7).  
2 Test by turning on the television and  
changing channels.  
Repeat the procedure until you find the code that allows  
correct operation.  
To return to the previous screen  
Press [RETURN].  
If your television brand is not listed or if the code listed for  
your television does not allow control of your television, this  
remote control is not compatible with your television.  
To exit the screen  
Press [EXIT].  
[Note]  
If your television brand has more than one code listed, select the  
one that allows correct operation.  
RQT8859  
22  
Watching analogue and digital broadcasts  
[Note] (Digital broadcast only)  
This unit can receive Standard Definition (SD) broadcasts, but is  
unable to receive High Definition (HD) broadcasts.  
When High Definition (HD) programmes are broadcast, “Unable to  
decode HD” is displayed in the digital channel information  
(below).  
REC  
OPEN/CLOSE  
2
3
This unit can receive free cable television but it cannot receive paid  
services.  
DVD  
TV  
Í
Í
2
ts  
VOL  
CH  
DRIVE  
s
a
SELECT  
AV  
Digital channel information  
While stopped  
Press [STATUS ] to show the information  
screen.  
PAGE  
CH  
dc  
2 3  
1
oa  
Numbered  
buttons  
3
4 5 6  
lbr  
ANALOGUE  
CH  
8 9  
0
7
ANALOGUE  
CH  
G-Code  
DELETE  
INPUT  
SELECT  
Programme name  
Channel  
SKIP  
SLOW/SEARCH  
ndgita  
Station Name  
PAUSE  
PLAY/x1.3  
EXIT  
STOP  
a
Progress of the current programme  
Signal Quality (below)  
STATUS  
gue  
STATUS  
I
o
l
a
n
Current time  
Group  
OK  
352 ABC2  
No Signal  
All Services  
18:53  
inga  
3,4,2,1  
OPTION  
RETURN  
Change the  
group  
(below).  
ABC News  
19:00 - 19:30  
Encrypted  
Change Favourite  
h
c
t
NOW  
Multi Audio  
info  
OK  
“Red”  
CREATE  
CHAPTER  
DISPLAY  
AUDIO  
MANUAL SKIP  
PG  
a
“Blue”  
Programme is broadcast in multi-channel  
ol/W  
This unit is a DVD recorder with an integrated DVB tuner. This  
means that you can receive and record both analogue and  
terrestrial digital channels without having to connect an additional  
DVB receiving unit.  
sound (43, DVB Multi Audio)  
tr  
on  
The parental ratings level is displayed.  
c
During scrambled broadcasting  
(Cannot be viewed with this unit.)  
ote  
Select the channel  
m
e
r
Broadcast time  
d
n
1 Turn on the television and select the  
To switch information of the current programme and the next  
programme  
Press [2, 1].  
appropriate AV input to suit the  
connections to this unit.  
ona  
i
s
i
To select the information for other stations  
Press [3, 4].  
Press [OK] to watch the selected station.  
To show detailed information about the programme  
v
2 Press [Í DVD] to turn the unit on.  
le  
te  
3 Press [W X CH] to select the channel.  
Everytime you change the station, a digital channel information  
appear automatically (terrestrial digital channels only).  
Channels are displayed in the order of digital channels first,  
and then followed by analogue channels.  
our  
Press [STATUS ] again (only when “info ” is displayed).  
y
h
Signal Quality  
tc  
Digital channel  
No Signal: The digital broadcast signal is not being received.  
Bad Signal: Due to poor signal conditions, etc., the digital broadcast  
signal has been interrupted.  
No Service:No broadcasts are currently available.  
uptoma  
You can also select the channel with the numbered buttons.  
t
If “No Signal” or “Bad Signal” is displayed, check the  
following:  
Adjust the position and direction of the aerial.  
Check that the current digital broadcast channel is correctly  
broadcasting.  
e
e.g.,  
5:  
[0] [0] [5]  
S
15:  
[0] [1] [5]  
3
115: [1] [1] [5]  
EP  
Analogue channel  
T
S
To change the group to easily select one of your  
favourite channels (69)  
You can press the “Blue” button to change the group (e.g., TV, Radio,  
Edit Favourites screen) and then press [3, 4] to select the channel.  
You can also select the channel with the following steps.  
1
Press [ANALOGUE CH].  
2
Press the numbered buttons to select the channel.  
To change the length of time digital channel  
e.g.,  
5:  
[0] [5]  
information is displayed  
15:  
[1] [5]  
You can change the length of time digital channel information  
(67, On-Screen Messages).  
If New service message appears  
When a new DVB channel is added this unit will be informed  
automatically. Then the confirmation message appears. If you  
select “Yes” on the display, Auto-Setup starts (all channel  
settings and all created favourite groups are deleted. The  
timer recording programmes are also cancelled.).  
[Note]  
By following the information sent from the station, you can check  
the programme information.  
If you record a digital radio broadcast or a digital broadcast that is  
not being received correctly, digital channel information is also  
recorded and will remain visible during playback.  
New Service  
A New DVB Service has been found.  
Start the DVB Auto-Setup?  
Selecting the DVB Auto-Setup will delete  
the current Favourite settings and all Timer Programmes.  
If a software update is available, a notification is  
displayed on the digital channel information  
Yes  
No  
352 ABC2  
No Signal  
All Services  
18:53  
ABC News  
19:00 - 19:30  
Encrypted  
Change Favourite  
RETURN  
OK  
NOW  
Multi Audio  
Software update  
Software update  
RQT8859  
PG  
The display/hide setting can be changed (67, New Service  
Press the “Red” button to launch software update screen.  
Message).  
23  
Recording television programmes  
3 Press [W X CH] to select the channel.  
2
Channels are displayed in the order of digital channels first,  
and then followed by analogue channels.  
Digital channel  
REC  
OPEN/CLOSE  
You can also select the channel with the numbered buttons.  
3
5
e.g.,  
5:  
[0] [0] [5]  
VOL  
CH  
DRIVE  
SELECT  
AV  
15:  
[0] [1] [5]  
1
PAGE  
CH  
115: [1] [1] [5]  
2 3  
4 5 6  
1
Analogue channel  
Numbered  
buttons  
3
ANALOGUE  
CH  
8 9  
7
ANALOGUE  
CH  
G-Code  
DELETE  
INPUT  
0
SELECT  
You can also select the channel with the following steps.  
SKIP  
SLOW/SEARCH  
1
2
e.g.,  
Press [ANALOGUE CH].  
;
Press the numbered buttons to select the channel.  
PAUSE  
PLAY/x1.3  
EXIT  
STOP  
5:  
[0] [5]  
15:  
[1] [5]  
STATUS  
I
4 Press [REC MODE] to select the  
recording mode (XP, SP, LP or EP).  
OK  
3,4,2,1  
OPTION  
RETURN  
OK  
Remaining time  
on the disc  
CREATE  
CHAPTER  
DISPLAY  
AUDIO  
REC  
MANUAL SKIP  
AUDIO  
REC MODE TIME SLIP PROG/CHECK  
To record sound using LPCM (XP mode only):  
Set the “Audio Mode for XP Recording” to “LPCM” in the  
Setup menu (66).  
5
4
See also “Important notes for recording” (8).  
Depending on the type of disc used for recording or the type of  
broadcast, there may be restrictions on the title you are trying to  
record.  
5 Press [¥ REC] to start recording.  
[RAM] It is not possible to record continuously from one side of a  
double sided disc to the other. You will need to eject the disc and  
turn it over.  
[+RW] You can create Top Menu using “Create Top Menu” (62).  
Recording or editing on the disc may delete the menu. In that case,  
create the menu again.  
When recording a digital radio broadcast or a digital broadcast that  
is not being received correctly, the digital channel information  
(23) is also recorded.  
REC  
Recording will take place on open space on the HDD or on  
disc. Data will not be overwritten.  
You cannot change the channel or recording mode during  
recording.  
You can record while the unit is in standby for timer  
recording. However, once the time for the timer recording to  
begin is reached, any recording taking place will stop and  
the timer recording will begin.  
[HDD] [RAM] (Analogue broadcast only) When “Rec for High  
Speed Copy” is set to “Off” (65), you can change the  
audio being received by pressing [AUDIO] during recording.  
(Does not affect the recording of audio.)  
[SD]  
It is not possible to record onto a card.  
[RAM] [-RW‹V›] [+R] [+R]DL] [+RW]  
To use a new disc, formatting is necessary.  
Preparation  
Turn on the television and select the appropriate video input to suit  
the connections to this unit.  
To pause recording  
Turn on this unit.  
Press [;].  
Press again to restart recording.  
You can also press [¥ REC] to restart.  
(Title is not split into separate titles.)  
1 Press [DRIVE SELECT] to select the  
HDD or DVD drive.  
The HDD or DVD indicator lights up on the unit’s display.  
To stop recording  
Press [].  
2
If you selected the DVD drive  
From the start to the end of the recording is called one title.  
[-R] [-RW‹V›] [+R] [+RW] It takes about 30 seconds for the unit to  
complete recording management information after recording  
finishes.  
In order to play DVD-R, DVD-RW (DVD-Video format) and +R  
(recorded with this unit) on other DVD players, it is necessary to  
finalise them (62).  
Press [< OPEN/CLOSE] on the main  
unit to open the tray and insert a disc.  
Press the button again to close the tray.  
When using 8 cm DVD-RAM, or 8 cm DVD-R, remove the  
disc from the cartridge.  
Cartridge disc  
Insert label-up with the  
arrow facing in.  
Insert label-up.  
Quick Start (68)  
1 Sec. Quick Start for Recording & EPG Display  
(When connecting to TV using 21-pin Scart, COMPONENT  
VIDEO, VIDEO or S VIDEO terminals)  
From the power on, recording on DVD-RAM and HDD starts in  
about 1 second after the REC button is pressed. If the GUIDE  
button is pressed while the unit is off, the Electronic Program  
Guide (EPG) displays in less than 1 second. (Quick Start Mode)  
Insert fully.  
Automatic drive select function  
[RAM] [Only for discs with the write-protect tab on the cartridge  
set to “PROTECT” (60, Cartridge-protection)]  
[DVD-V] [VCD] [CD]  
If the unit is recording to the HDD or stopped, it  
automatically switches to the DVD drive when a disc is  
inserted.  
If you eject a disc and close the disc tray, the HDD drive is  
automatically selected.  
“Quick Start” is set to “On” at the time of purchase.  
Depending on the type of TV or the connected terminal, it may  
take time to display the screen.  
[Note]  
Startup takes up to a minute when:  
You play a disc or start recording to discs other than DVD-RAM.  
You want to make other operations.  
–The clock has not been set.  
RQT8859  
24  
Recording modes and approximate recording times  
Depending on the content being recorded, the recording times may become shorter than indicated.  
(The times provided on this chart are an estimate.)  
HDD  
DVD-RAM  
DVD-R  
DVD-RW  
+R  
DVD-R DL§3  
(8.5 GB)  
+R DL§3  
(8.5 GB)  
s
Single-  
Double-  
sided§1  
(9.4 GB)  
Recording Mode  
[EX77]  
[EX87]  
(250 GB)  
sided  
+RW  
(160 GB)  
(4.7 GB)  
(4.7 GB)  
me  
a
XP (High picture  
quality recording  
mode)  
ogr  
36 hours  
70 hours  
55 hours  
1 hour  
2 hours  
1 hour  
1 hour 45 min.  
1 hour 45 min.  
onpr  
SP (Standard  
recording mode)  
i
111 hours  
2 hours  
4 hours  
4 hours  
8 hours  
2 hours  
4 hours  
3 hours 35 min.  
7 hours 10 min.  
3 hours 35 min.  
7 hours 10 min.  
s
i
v
le  
LP (Long  
recording mode)  
138 hours  
284 hours  
222 hours  
443 hours  
EP (Extra long  
8 hours  
16 hours  
8 hours  
14 hours 20 min.  
ingte  
recording mode)§4 (212hours§2  
)
(333hours§2  
)
(6 hours§2  
)
(12 hours§2  
)
(6 hours§2  
)
(10 hours 45 min.§2  
)
d
r
o
c
Approximately  
9 hours with video  
quality equivalent  
to LP mode.  
FR (Flexible  
284 hours  
Recording  
maximum  
Mode)§4  
8 hours  
443 hours  
maximum  
8 hours  
maximum  
8 hours  
maximum  
Re  
maximum  
14 hours 20 min.  
for one side  
§1 It is not possible to record or play continuously from one side of a double sided disc to the other.  
§2 When “Recording time in EP mode” is set to “EP (6 Hours)” in the Setup menu (65).  
The sound quality is better when using “EP (6 Hours)” than when using “EP (8 Hours)”.  
§3 You cannot record directly to DVD-R DL and +R DL discs with this unit. The table shows the recording time when copying.  
[+R]DL] You cannot copy in “EP” or “FR (recordings 5 hours or longer)” mode.  
When recording to the HDD in “EP” or “FR (recordings 5 hours or longer)” mode , you cannot perform high-speed copy to +R or +RW discs.  
§4  
[RAM] When recording to DVD-RAM using “EP (8 Hours)” mode, play may not be possible on DVD players that are compatible with DVD-RAM.  
Use “EP (6 Hours)” mode if playback may be on other equipment.  
[HDD] You can record up to 500 titles on HDD. (When continuously recording for long durations, titles are automatically divided every 8 hours.)  
[RAM] [-R] [-RW‹V›] You can record up to 99 titles on one disc.  
[+R] [+RW] You can record up to 49 titles on one disc.  
FR (Flexible Recording Mode)  
You can set FR (Flexible Recording) mode when copying or programming timer recordings.  
The unit automatically selects a recording rate between XP and EP (8 Hours) that will enable the recordings to fit in the remaining disc space with  
the best possible recording quality.  
For example with a 90 minute recording to an unused DVD-RAM, the picture quality is adjusted to between “XP” and “SP”.  
When recording to the HDD, picture quality is automatically adjusted to precisely fit a copied title on a 4.7 GB disc.  
All the recording modes from XP to EP appear in the display.  
Disc Insertion/Ejection  
When the format confirmation screen is displayed  
When removing a recorded disc  
[RAM] [-RW‹V›] [+R] [+R]DL] [+RW]  
[-R] [-R]DL] [-RW‹V›] [+R] [+R]DL]  
When you insert a new disc or a disc recorded on a computer or  
other equipment, a format confirmation screen is displayed. Format  
the disc to use it. However, all the recorded contents are deleted.  
The following screen appears when you have not processed the disc  
for play on other equipment.  
Finalise  
Finalise the disc so that it can be played  
on other DVD players.  
Note: Recording or Editing is not possible  
after finalising. This may take up to min.  
Format  
This disc is not formatted properly.  
Do you want to format the disc now ?  
Press the REC button to start finalise.  
Press the OPEN/CLOSE button to exit.  
The disc cannot be played on other  
DVD players without finalising.  
Yes  
No  
SELECT  
RETURN  
OK  
To finalise the disc  
Press [¥ REC] on the main unit.  
Press [2, 1] to select “Yes” and press [OK].  
You cannot stop this process once you have started it.  
If you want to set the background, play menu select or provide a  
disc name, select “Top Menu” (62), “Auto-Play Select” (62) or  
“Disc Name” (60) in “DVD Management” before finalising.  
To format a disc  
“Deleting all the contents of a disc or card—Format” (61)  
RQT8859  
To open the tray without disc finalisation  
Press [< OPEN/CLOSE] on the main unit.  
25  
Recording television programmes  
Recording settings for High Speed  
Copy  
REC  
OPEN/CLOSE  
When copying in high speed mode to DVD-R, DVD-R DL,  
DVD-RW (DVD-Video format), +R, +R DL and +RW, set “Rec  
for High Speed Copy” to “On” before recording to the HDD.  
(The default setting is “On”. 65)  
1
¥ REC  
However, some restrictions apply:  
Refer to the “Selecting Audio for Recording” and “About the  
aspect when recording a programme” for more information (8).  
DVD  
TV  
Í
Í
VOL  
CH  
DRIVE  
SELECT  
AV  
DRIVE  
SELECT  
PAGE  
CH  
[Note]  
2 3  
4 5 6  
1
If you do not intend to copy titles in high speed mode to DVD-R,  
DVD-R DL, DVD-RW (DVD-Video format), +R, +R DL and +RW, set  
“Rec for High Speed Copy” to “Off”.  
Numbered  
buttons  
ANALOGUE  
CH  
8 9  
7
G-Code  
DELETE  
INPUT  
0
SELECT  
SKIP  
SLOW/SEARCH  
PAUSE  
PLAY/x1.3  
EXIT  
STOP  
1
STATUS  
STATUS  
I
FUNCTION  
MENU  
DIRECT  
NAVIGATOR  
OK  
3,4,2,1  
OPTION  
RETURN  
RETURN  
OK  
CREATE  
DISPLAY  
CHAPTER  
AUDIO  
REC  
MANUAL SKIP  
REC MODE TIME SLIP PROG/CHECK  
To specify a time to stop recording—  
One Touch Recording  
[HDD] [RAM] [-R] [-RW‹V›] [+R] [+RW]  
During recording  
Press [¥ REC] on the main unit to select the recording  
time.  
You can specify up to 4 hours later.  
The unit display changes as shown below.  
OFF 0:30 ""# OFF 1:00 ""# OFF 1:30 ""# OFF 2:00  
^" Counter (cancel) ,"" OFF 4:00  
,"" OFF 3:00 ,}  
This does not work during timer recordings (28) or while using  
Flexible Recording (27).  
The unit turns off automatically after the time to stop recording is  
reached.  
To cancel  
Press [¥ REC] on the main unit several times until the counter  
appears.  
The time to stop recording is cancelled; however, recording  
continues.  
To stop recording  
Press [].  
RQT8859  
26  
5
When you want to start recording  
Flexible Recording  
(Recording that fits the remaining disc space)  
Press [3, 4, 2, 1] to select “Start”  
[HDD] [RAM] [-R] [-RW‹V›] [+R] [+RW]  
and press [OK].  
The unit sets the best possible picture quality that fits the recording  
within the remaining disc space. The recording mode becomes FR  
mode.  
Recording starts.  
XP  
SP  
LP  
EP  
All the recording modes from XP to EP appear in  
the display.  
s
Using “Flexible Rec” is convenient in these  
kinds of situations.  
To exit the screen without recording  
Press [RETURN].  
e.g., HDD  
me  
[RAM] [-R] [-RW‹V›] [+R] [+RW]  
a
When the amount of free space on the disc makes selecting an  
appropriate recording mode difficult  
When you want to record a long programme with the best picture  
quality possible  
HDD  
To stop recording partway  
Remaining  
time of  
recording  
REC 0:59  
21 DVB  
ABC2  
Press [].  
ogr  
To show the remaining time  
Press [STATUS ].  
L R  
onpr  
[HDD]  
i
s
i
When you want to record a title to HDD so that it can then be  
copied to fit one 4.7 GB disc perfectly  
v
le  
You do not need to edit the recorded title, or change the recording  
mode when copying, to fit the disc space  
Playing while you are recording  
e.g., Recording a 90 minute programme to disc  
[HDD] [RAM]  
ingte  
d
r
If you select XP mode, the programme will not fit one disc.  
o
c
Playing from the beginning of the title you are  
recording—Chasing playback  
If you try to record a 90 minute  
programme in XP mode, only the  
first 60 minutes will fit on the disc  
and the 30 minute balance will not  
Re  
Press [1] (PLAY) during recording.  
There is no sound output while searching forward or backward.  
4.7GB  
DVD-RAM  
4.7GB  
DVD-RAM  
get recorded.  
Another disc is necessary.  
To stop play  
Press [].  
If you select SP mode, the programme will fit one disc.  
However there will be 30 minutes  
remaining disc space.  
To stop recording  
2 seconds after play stops, press [].  
4.7GB  
DVD-RAM  
To stop timer recording  
2 seconds after play stops  
If you select “Flexible Rec” the programme will fit one disc  
perfectly.  
1
2
Press [].  
Press [2, 1] to select “Stop Recording” and press [OK].  
Playing a title previously recorded while recording—  
Simultaneous rec and play  
4.7GB  
DVD-RAM  
You can also change the drive and play while recording. Press  
[DRIVE SELECT].  
Necessary space for recording  
1 Press [DIRECT NAVIGATOR] during  
recording.  
Preparation  
Select the channel or the external input to record.  
Press [DRIVE SELECT] to select the HDD or DVD drive.  
2 Press [3, 4, 2, 1] to select a title  
1
While stopped  
and press [OK].  
Press [FUNCTION MENU].  
There is no sound output while searching forward or  
2 Press [3, 4] to select “To Others”  
backward.  
and press [OK].  
To stop play  
Press [].  
3 Press [3, 4] to select “Flexible Rec”  
and press [OK].  
To exit the Direct Navigator screen  
Press [DIRECT NAVIGATOR].  
Flexible Rec  
Maximum recording time  
This is the maximum recording  
time in EP (8 Hours) mode.  
Record in FR mode.  
Maximum rec. time 8 Hour 00 Min.  
To stop recording  
After play stops  
Set rec. time  
8 Hour 00 Min.  
Start  
Cancel  
1
2
Press [DIRECT NAVIGATOR] to exit screen.  
If the recording is on the other drive  
Press [DRIVE SELECT] to select the recording drive.  
Press [].  
4 Press [2, 1] to select “Hour” and  
3
“Min.” and press [3, 4] to set the  
recording time.  
To stop timer recording  
After play stops  
1
2
You can also set the recording time with the numbered  
buttons.  
Press [DIRECT NAVIGATOR] to exit screen.  
If the recording is on the other drive  
You cannot record more than 8 hours.  
Press [DRIVE SELECT] to select the recording drive.  
Press [].  
Press [2, 1] to select “Stop Recording” and press [OK].  
3
4
[Note]  
“Chasing playback” and “Simultaneous rec and play” can only be  
used with programmes of the same encoding system (PAL/NTSC).  
RQT8859  
27  
Timer recording  
1 Press [GUIDE].  
REC  
OPEN/CLOSE  
Sat 13.01.07 19:45  
Favourite  
All Services  
TV Guide:  
ABC 1  
Landscape  
Prog. Type  
All Types  
Sat 13.01.  
Emmerdale: In today’s show we will...  
W
X
Í/I  
CH  
Time:  
ABC 1  
ABC 2  
News  
News  
DVD  
TV  
Í
Í DVD  
Í
News  
VOL  
CH  
DRIVE  
SELECT  
AV  
+24 Hr  
Prog. Type  
Favourite  
PAGE  
CH  
SELECT  
TIMER REC  
Info  
Guide Change Display Mode  
Page  
2 3  
1
RETURN  
Page  
W X  
CH  
4 5 6  
ANALOGUE  
CH  
2 Press [3, 4, 2, 1] to select the  
8 9  
7
G-Code  
DELETE  
INPUT  
programme.  
0
SELECT  
SKIP  
SLOW/SEARCH  
3 Press [OK].  
PAUSE  
PLAY/x1.3  
EXIT  
STOP  
1:58 SP  
12:54:00 15. 7. TUE  
Timer  
Remain  
HDD 30:24 SP DVD  
Recording  
STATUS  
HDD  
DVD  
STATUS  
EXIT  
I
Name  
Date  
Start  
16:00  
Stop  
17:00  
Mode  
GUIDE  
1 ARD 15. 7. TUE  
HDD SP  
All Services : ARD  
Fliege-Die Talkshow  
Programme Name  
3,4,2,1  
OK  
OK  
Confirm the programme (start and end time) by using a TV  
magazine, etc. and make corrections if necessary using  
[3, 4, 2, 1] (31, step 3).  
OPTION  
RETURN  
RETURN  
CREATE  
DISPLAY  
CHAPTER  
AUDIO  
REC  
MANUAL SKIP  
“Red”  
“Green”  
“Blue”  
Yellow”  
REC MODE TIME SLIP PROG/CHECK  
4 Press [OK].  
The timer programme is stored and the timer icon is  
mdorise pgilralsyed.  
See also “Important notes for recording” (8).  
15:30  
16:00  
16:30  
0
Depending on the type of disc used for recording or the type of  
broadcast, there may be restrictions on the title you are trying to  
record.  
Timer icon  
Fliege-Die Talkshow  
Abenteuer...  
F” lights on the unit’s display to indicate timer recording  
standby has been activated.  
Repeat steps 2–4 to programme other recordings.  
Press [Í DVD] to turn the unit off.  
[HDD] [RAM] [-R] [-RW‹V›] [+R] [+RW]  
You can enter up to 32 programmes up to a month in advance.  
(Each daily or weekly programme is counted as one programme.)  
[RAM] [-RW‹V›] [+R] [+R]DL] [+RW]  
To use a new disc, formatting is necessary.  
[Note]  
If “NTSC” has been selected for “TV System” (72), the TV Guide  
system cannot be used.  
Preparation  
Turn on the television and select the appropriate video input to suit  
the connections to this unit.  
If recording to DVD, insert a disc that you can use for recording  
(24).  
Make sure that the clock settings are correct (73).  
To cancel a timer recording on the TV Guide  
screen  
1 Press [3, 4, 2, 1] to select the programme in the TV Guide  
and press [OK].  
(Confirmation screen appears.)  
2 Press [2] to select “Yes” and press [OK]. (“F” in the TV Guide  
disappears.)  
Using the TV Guide system to make  
timer recordings (Digital broadcast only)  
The TV Guide system provides programme information from the  
digital broadcasts station displayed on the television like a TV  
programme magazine. Setting up to record a broadcast is easy too.  
Simply select the desired programme from the displayed list. You  
can also search for desired programmes by displaying only the  
programmes in a certain group.  
When the unit displays “No information  
available for analogue services” or the empty TV  
Guide list  
Sat 13.01.07 19:45  
TV Guide:  
ABC 1  
Sat 13.01.  
Landscape  
Prog. Type  
All Types  
Favourite  
All Services  
[Note]  
Emmerdale : In today’s show we will...  
Time:  
ABC 1  
ABC 2  
If the unit is disconnected from the AC mains, all programme data  
are lost.  
The “empty” field  
The programme list is available immediately if this unit has found a  
digital station and loaded the information in the memory. This  
process can take a while depending on the particular station.  
The programme list data are continuously downloaded in the  
background when the unit is turned on. That means that the  
programme list can sometimes change while you are looking at it.  
Analogue broadcasts can be recorded manually or with the G-CODE  
system (30, 31).  
Some digital broadcast may not send programme information.  
Set the timer recording manually or with the G-CODE system (30,  
31).  
[Note]  
The receipt of the TV Guide system data is only possible via the  
aerial input of this unit. The receipt of the TV Guide data via  
externally connected satellite receivers is not possible.  
Programme information about analogue broadcasts is not  
displayed in the TV Guide system and “No information available for  
analogue services” is displayed.  
Before using the TV Guide system  
The television programme list is not displayed immediately after  
purchasing this unit.  
To cancel recording when recording has already  
begun (32)  
To release the unit from recording standby  
32)  
(➡  
RQT8859  
Notes on timer recording (32)  
28  
Selecting the programme from the desired  
programme type or group  
Operations in the TV Guide system  
Basic operations  
This function lets you display a TV Guide list sorted by programme  
type (e.g. Movies, Sport) or group (e.g. TV, Radio).  
Press [GUIDE] to switch between Landscape view and  
Portrait view.  
1
From the desired programme type  
Landscape view  
Sat 13.01.07 19:45  
Favourite  
TV Guide:  
ABC 1  
Sat 13.01.  
Landscape  
g
Prog. Type  
All Types  
All Services  
Press the “Yellow” button to display  
in  
d
r
Emmerdale: In today’s show we will...  
Time:  
ABC 1  
ABC 2  
the list of programme type.  
o
From the desired group  
News  
News  
Press the “Blue” button to display the  
list of groups.  
rec  
e
m
i
News  
T
2 Press [3, 4] to select the desired  
+24 Hr  
Prog. Type  
Favourite  
SELECT  
TIMER REC  
Info  
Guide Change Display Mode  
Page  
item.  
RETURN  
Page  
Prog.Type  
All Types  
Favourite  
All Services  
All Types  
Movies  
News  
All Services  
Free TV  
Radio  
Favourite 1  
Favourite 2  
Favourite 3  
Favourite 4  
Portrait view  
Entertainment  
Sat 13.01.07 19:45  
Favourite  
All Services  
TV Guide:  
ABC 1  
Sat 13.01.  
Portrait  
Prog. Type  
All Types  
Sport  
Children’s  
Education  
Lifestyle  
ABC 1  
ABC 2  
Art/Culture  
3 Press [OK].  
A list appears with all programmes of the selected item.  
When you select the Landscape view, the unit displays  
programmes in grey that do not belong to the selected  
programme type.  
-24 Hr  
SELECT  
+24 Hr  
Prog. Type  
Favourite  
TIMER REC  
RETURN  
Page  
Info  
Page  
Guide Change Display Mode  
Sat 13.01.07 19:45  
Favourite  
TV Guide:  
ABC 1  
Sat 13.01.  
Landscape  
e.g., Programme  
type, “News” is  
selected in step  
2 of Landscape  
view.  
Prog. Type  
News  
All Services  
To change channels Landscape view  
Press [3, 4] to select a channel.  
Emmerdale: In today’s show we will...  
Time:  
ABC 1  
ABC 2  
Portrait view  
Press [2, 1] to select a channel.  
News  
News  
The TV Guide list appears for this channel.  
News  
To view a  
Jump ahead 24 hours  
+24 Hr  
Prog. Type  
Favourite  
programme list for  
another day  
Press the “Green” button to jump ahead  
by one day.  
SELECT  
TIMER REC  
Info  
Guide Change Display Mode  
Page  
RETURN  
Page  
Jump back 24 hours  
Press the “Red” button.  
[Note]  
The broadcasters allocate individual programmes to topic  
areas. This function does not work properly unless the  
information which distinguishes the programme type and  
groups sent from broadcast stations is correct.  
You can only jump back to the current  
date. Past information cannot be viewed.  
To browse through  
the TV Guide list  
Press [W X CH].  
4 Press [3, 4, 2, 1] to select the  
To see programme  
information  
(Programmes with the  
Press [STATUS  
].  
programme.  
Additional information (programme name,  
programme duration, broadcast time,  
description) is available for these  
programmes.  
To return to the previous TV Guide list before you have selected  
the programme type or groups  
symbol)  
TV Guide  
Sat 13.01.07 19:45  
Select “All Types” of the programme type and “All Services” of the  
groups in step 2 above.  
Sat 13.01.  
Spending Other People’s Money  
ABC ONE, Lifestyle  
19:30-20:00. 30min.  
To return to the previous screen  
Press [RETURN].  
A
flashy car salesman loses his cool when stingy friend  
takes over his wallet. He’s lorced to sell his possessions  
at car boot sale to pay for food.  
a
To exit the screen  
Press [EXIT].  
TIMER REC  
RETURN  
Return to List  
Press [3, 4] to scroll up and down.  
To show other pages  
Press [CH W] (Previous) or [X CH] (Next).  
Press [STATUS  
programme list.  
] again to return to the  
RQT8859  
29  
Timer recording  
Using G-CODE system to make timer  
recordings  
DVD  
TV  
Entering G-CODE numbers is an easy way of timer recording. You can  
Í DVD  
Í
Í
find these numbers in TV listings in newspapers and magazines.  
VOL  
CH  
DRIVE  
SELECT  
AV  
DRIVE  
SELECT  
[Note]  
PAGE  
CH  
The G-CODE system is not supported for digital broadcasts.  
2 3  
4 5 6  
1
Numbered  
buttons  
ANALOGUE  
CH  
1 Press [G-Code].  
1:58 SP  
HDD 30:24 SP DVD  
8 9  
7
G-Code  
DELETE  
INPUT  
G-Code  
Record  
Remain  
0
SELECT  
G-Code  
12:53:00 15. 7. TUE  
SKIP  
SLOW/SEARCH  
PAUSE  
PLAY/x1.3  
EXIT  
STOP  
STATUS  
Input G-Code Number 0-9, and press OK.  
I
2 Press the numbered buttons to enter  
3,4,2,1  
OK  
OK  
the G-CODE number.  
OPTION  
RETURN  
Press [2] to move back to correct a digit.  
CREATE  
CHAPTER  
DISPLAY  
AUDIO  
REC  
MANUAL SKIP  
“Blue”  
3 Press [OK].  
REC MODE TIME SLIP PROG/CHECK  
PROG/CHECK  
REC MODE  
1:58 SP  
12:54:00 15. 7. TUE  
Timer  
Remain  
HDD 30:24 SP DVD  
Recording  
HDD  
DVD  
Name  
Date  
Start  
19:00  
Stop  
20:00  
Mode  
SP  
2A ARD 15. 7.TUE  
HDD  
All Services : ARD  
Programme Name  
Confirm the programme (start and end time) by using a TV  
magazine, etc. and make corrections if necessary using  
[3, 4, 2, 1] (31, step 3).  
See also “Important notes for recording” (8).  
When “-- ---” appears in the “Name” column, you cannot set  
timer recording. Press [3, 4] to select desired programme  
position. After you have entered the information of a TV  
station, it is kept in the unit’s memory.  
Depending on the type of disc used for recording or the type of  
broadcast, there may be restrictions on the title you are trying to  
record.  
[HDD] [RAM] [-R] [-RW‹V›] [+R] [+RW]  
4 Press [OK].  
You can enter up to 32 programmes up to a month in advance.  
(Each daily or weekly programme is counted as one programme.)  
The timer programme is stored and the timer icon is  
displayed.  
[RAM] [-RW‹V›] [+R] [+R]DL] [+RW]  
To use a new disc, formatting is necessary.  
No. Name  
01  
Timer icon  
ARD  
Preparation  
Turn on the television and select the appropriate video input to suit  
the connections to this unit.  
If recording to DVD, insert a disc that you can use for recording  
(24).  
Make sure that the clock settings are correct (73).  
F” lights on the unit’s display to indicate timer recording  
standby has been activated.  
12:56:00 15. 7. TUE  
Drive  
HDD  
space  
Mode  
SP  
Stop  
20:00  
DVD  
Check to make sure “OK”  
HDD  
OK  
is displayed (33).  
Programme  
Repeat steps 1–4 to programme other recordings.  
Press [Í DVD] to turn the unit off.  
To cancel recording when recording has already  
begun (32)  
To release the unit from recording standby  
G-CODE is a registered trademark of  
Gemstar Development Corporation. The  
G-CODE system is manufactured under  
license from Gemstar Development  
Corporation.  
(32)  
Notes on timer recording (32)  
RQT8859  
30  
Manually programming timer  
recordings  
1 Press [PROG/CHECK].  
1:58 SP  
HDD 30:24 SP DVD  
Timer  
Remain  
Recording  
12:56:00 15. 7. TUE  
g
HDD  
Drive  
No. Name  
F01 ARD  
Date  
15. 7.TUE  
Start Stop  
20:00  
DVD Mode  
space  
in  
HDD  
19:00  
SP  
OK  
d
r
New Timer Programme  
o
rec  
e
2 Press [3, 4] to select “New Timer  
m
i
Programme” and press [OK].  
T
3 Press [1] to move through the items  
and change the items with [3, 4].  
1:58 SP  
HDD 30:24 SP DVD  
Timer  
Remain  
Recording  
12:54:00 15. 7. TUE  
HDD  
DVD  
Name  
Date  
Start  
22:00  
Stop  
22:30  
Mode  
2A ARD 15. 7.TUE  
HDD SP  
All Services : ARD  
Programme Name  
When “Name” is selected, you can press the “Blue” button to  
change the group [e.g., TV, Radio, Edit Favourites screen  
(69)] and then press [3, 4] to select the channel you  
want to record.  
Press and hold [3, 4] to alter the Start (Start time) and  
Stop (Finish time) in 30-minute increments.  
You can also set Name (Programme position/TV Station  
Name), Date, Start (Start time), and Stop (Finish time) with  
the numbered buttons.  
Date  
[. Date:  
Current date up to one month later minus  
one day  
l
l
l
;:  
Daily timer: SUN-SAT>MON-SAT>MON-FRI  
;:  
a. Weekly timer: SUN>--->SAT  
You can also press [DRIVE SELECT] to select the recording  
drive.  
When the recording drive is “DVD” and there is not enough  
remaining space, recording automatically switches to the  
“HDD” (33, Relief Recording).  
You can also press [REC MODE] to change the recording  
mode.  
[HDD] RENEW (Auto Renewal Recording) (33)  
ON!)OFF  
Programme Name  
Press [2, 1] to select “Programme Name” and press [OK].  
(59, Entering text)  
4 Press [OK].  
The timer programme is stored and the timer icon is  
displayed.  
No. Name  
01  
Timer icon  
ARD  
F” lights on the unit’s display to indicate timer recording  
standby has been activated.  
12:56:00 15. 7. TUE  
Drive  
HDD  
space  
Mode  
SP  
Stop  
20:00  
DVD  
Check to make sure “OK”  
HDD  
OK  
is displayed (33).  
Programme  
Repeat steps 2–4 to programme other recordings.  
Press [Í DVD] to turn the unit off.  
To cancel recording when recording has already  
begun (32)  
To release the unit from recording standby  
(32)  
RQT8859  
Notes on timer recording (32)  
31  
Timer recording  
To cancel recording when recording  
has already begun  
DVD  
TV  
Í
Í
1
While the unit is on  
VOL  
CH  
DRIVE  
SELECT  
AV  
DRIVE  
SELECT  
Press [DRIVE SELECT] to select the  
recording drive and press [].  
Stop Recording  
PAGE  
CH  
2 3  
1
4 5 6  
ANALOGUE  
CH  
Timer recording in progress.  
Stop this timer recording?  
It will be cancelled if you stop.  
8 9  
0
7
G-Code  
DELETE  
INPUT  
SELECT  
DELETE ¢  
SKIP  
SLOW/SEARCH  
Cancel  
Stop Recording  
SELECT  
RETURN  
OK  
PAUSE  
PLAY/x1.3  
EXIT  
STOP  
STATUS  
2 Press [2, 1] to select “Stop  
I
Recording” and press [OK].  
If you stop a timer recording, it will be cancelled. However, if  
you have set a weekly or daily timer recording, the recording  
will start from the next time the timer recording is set.  
3,4,2,1  
OK  
OK  
OPTION  
RETURN  
OPTION  
“Red”  
CREATE  
DISPLAY  
CHAPTER  
AUDIO  
REC  
MANUAL SKIP  
To release the unit from recording  
standby  
REC MODE TIME SLIP PROG/CHECK  
PROG/CHECK  
Even when the unit is turned off, you can display the timer  
recording list by pressing [PROG/CHECK].  
1 Press [PROG/CHECK].  
2 Press [3, 4] to select the programme  
and press the “Red” button.  
The timer icon “F” (33) disappears from the timer  
recording list.  
You cannot cancel timer recording standby mode as long as  
even one timer icon “F” (33) remains in the timer  
recording list.  
Press the “Red” button again to activate timer recording  
standby.  
Notes on timer recording  
When a timer recording is set, DVDs that were recorded using a  
different TV system cannot be played unless the TV system is  
changed in the Setup menu (72) or the timer recording has  
completed or has been cancelled.  
Timer recordings are activated regardless of whether the unit is  
turned on/off.  
Timer recordings begin when the set time is reached even when  
playing.  
Timer recordings do not begin while editing or copying in normal  
speed mode (51).  
If the unit is turned on when timer recording begins, it remains  
turned on after recording finishes. It does not turn off automatically.  
You can turn the unit off during timer recording.  
If the unit is not put in the timer recording standby mode at the last  
10 minutes before the programmed timer recording starting time,  
the “F” flashes on the unit’s display.  
When you programme successive timer recordings to start  
immediately one after the other, the unit cannot record the part at  
the beginning of the later programmes.  
Programme  
Programme  
Not recorded  
Recorded  
Recorded  
RQT8859  
32  
Check, change or delete a programme  
Even when the unit is turned off, you can display the timer  
Relief Recording  
When the recording drive is “DVD” and there is not enough  
remaining space, recording automatically switches to the “HDD”. If  
there is no disc in the tray or the disc cannot be recorded on or when  
timer recording starts while copying, the recording drive will be  
altered to the HDD.  
recording list by pressing [PROG/CHECK].  
Press [PROG/CHECK].  
g
The Direct Navigator shows which programmes were relief-  
Icons  
in  
F
[
W
Timer recording standby is activated.  
This programme is currently recording.  
The times overlap those in another programme.  
Recording of the programme with the later start time  
starts when the earlier programme finishes recording.  
You stopped a weekly or daily timer recording. The icon  
disappears the next time the timer programme starts  
recording.  
recorded (“ ” is displayed.) (34).  
d
r
If the time remaining on the HDD is insufficient, as much of the  
programme as possible will be recorded onto the HDD.  
o
rec  
e
m
i
Auto Renewal Recording  
T
[HDD]  
If you record a programme onto HDD repeatedly everyday or every  
week using timer recording, the unit will record the new programme  
over the old one.  
This function can be used only when weekly recording or daily  
recording is selected.  
F
X
The disc was full so the programme failed to record.  
The material was copy-protected so it was not  
recorded.  
The programme did not complete recording because  
the disc is dirty or some other reason.  
Timer programmes set to Auto Renewal Recording  
(right column).  
1 Press [PROG/CHECK].  
Titles that have been rerouted to the HDD  
(Displayed while recording.)  
2 Press [3, 4] to select the programme  
and press [OK].  
HDD Recording drive is set to HDD  
DVD Recording drive is set to DVD  
3 Press [2, 1] to select “RENEW”  
column.  
1:58 SP  
12:56:00 15. 7. TUE  
Timer  
Remain  
Date  
HDD 30:24 SP DVD  
Recording  
4 Press [3, 4] to select “ON” and press  
HDD  
Start Stop DVD  
Drive  
Mode  
No. Name  
space  
[OK].  
New Timer Programme  
1:58 SP  
12:54:00 15. 7. TUE  
Timer  
Remain  
HDD 30:24 SP DVD  
Recording  
HDD  
DVD  
RENEW  
ON  
Name  
Date  
SUN  
Start  
22:00  
Stop  
Mode  
SP  
2A ARD  
22:30 HDD  
All Services : ARD  
Press OK to store new programme.  
Programme Name  
OK  
RETURN  
[Note]  
Message displayed in the “Drive space” line  
If a programme set for Auto Renewal Recording is protected or  
while play back is taking place from the HDD, or while copying, the  
programme will not be overwritten. Instead the programme set for  
recording will be saved as a separate programme, and this  
programme will be the one to be overwritten when the next Auto  
Renewal Recording takes place.  
Playlists made from programmes that were set for Auto Renewal  
Recording are deleted along with auto renewal.  
When there is not enough space on the HDD, the programme may  
not be recorded completely.  
OK:  
Displayed if the recording can fit in the  
remaining space.  
> (Date): For recordings made daily or weekly, the display  
will show until when recordings can be made (up  
to a maximum of one month from the present  
time) based on the time remaining on the disc.  
! :  
It may not be possible to record because:  
there is not enough space left  
the number of possible titles has reached its  
maximum.  
Relief: Timer programmes that will be relief recorded to  
the HDD.  
To change a programme  
Press [3, 4] to select the programme and press [OK]. (31,  
step 3)  
To delete a programme  
Press [3, 4] to select the programme and press [DELETE ¢].  
You can also delete a programme with the following steps  
1
2
Press [3, 4] to select the programme and press [OPTION].  
Press [3, 4] to select “Delete” and press [OK].  
To exit the timer recording list  
Press [PROG/CHECK].  
Programmes that failed to record are deleted from the timer  
recording list at 4 a.m. two days later.  
RQT8859  
33  
Playing recorded video contents/Playing play-only discs  
Selecting recorded programmes (titles) to play—  
Direct Navigator  
2
[HDD] [RAM] [-R] [-R]DL] [-RW‹V›] [+R] [+R]DL] [+RW] [-RW‹VR›]  
(This function does not work with finalised discs.)  
REC  
OPEN/CLOSE  
1 Press [DIRECT NAVIGATOR].  
Thumbnail Display  
Table Display  
DIRECT NAVIGATOR  
HDD  
Title View  
008  
DIRECT NAVIGATOR  
HDD  
Title View  
3
VIDEO  
PICTURE  
VIDEO  
PICTURE  
Í
No. Name Date Day Time Name of title  
- - -  
007  
VOL  
CH  
DRIVE  
001  
002  
003  
004  
ARD 26. 9. FRI 13:30  
ZDF 27. 9. SAT 12:15  
AV2 3. 10. FRI 20:00  
ARD 3. 10. FRI 22:05  
SELECT  
AV  
ARD 10.10. FRI  
- - -  
ARD 11.10. SAT  
- - -  
1
Rec time  
0:52(SP)  
PAGE  
CH  
- - -  
005 AV2 4. 10. SAT 16:10  
006 ZDF 10.10. FRI 9:25  
007 ARD 10.10. FRI 13:30  
008 ARD 11.10. SAT 21:00  
---  
2 3  
1
Numbered  
buttons  
Previous  
Page 02/02  
Next  
Page 01/01  
4 5 6  
OK  
OK  
Previous  
Select  
OPTION  
Next  
Select  
OPTION  
ANALOGUE  
CH  
RETURN  
RETURN  
8 9  
7
G-Code  
Switching the Direct Navigator appearance  
DELETE  
INPUT  
0
SELECT  
1 Press [OPTION] while Thumbnail Display is displayed.  
2 Press [3, 4] to select “Table Display” and press [OK].  
The display appearance last used is saved even after the unit is  
turned off.  
SKIP  
SLOW/SEARCH  
6, 5  
:, 9  
PAUSE  
PLAY/x1.3  
EXIT  
STOP  
3
;
STATUS  
[HDD] To sort Title View for easy searching (Table Display only)  
This function is convenient when searching for one title to  
playback from many titles.  
I
DIRECT  
2;, ;1  
NAVIGATOR,  
Top Menu”  
1 Press [OPTION].  
OK  
2 Press [3, 4] to select “Sort” and press [OK].  
3 Press [3, 4] to select the item and press [OK].  
If you select an item other than “No.”  
The Direct Navigator screen will reappear after playback of the  
selected title has finished. (You cannot play titles continuously.)  
Skip and Time Slip will only function with the title currently being  
played back.  
3,4,2,1  
OPTION  
RETURN  
OK  
RETURN  
OPTION  
CREATE  
DISPLAY  
CHAPTER  
AUDIO  
REC  
MANUAL SKIP  
MANUAL SKIP  
AUDIO,  
“Red”  
REC MODE TIME SLIP PROG/CHECK  
CREATE  
CHAPTER  
TIME SLIP  
16:9 aspect programmes are recorded in 4:3 aspect in the  
following cases.  
If you exit the Direct Navigator screen, or switch to “PICTURE”  
Direct Navigator screen, the sorted Title View will be cancelled.  
[-R] [-RW‹V›] If you recorded using “EP” or “FR (recordings 5 hours  
or longer)” recording mode.  
2 [HDD] [RAM]  
If you recorded to a +R or +RW.  
Press the “Red” button to select “VIDEO”.  
If you recorded with the “Aspect for Recording” set to “4:3” in the  
Setup menu (65).  
DIRECT NAVIGATOR  
HDD  
Title View  
VIDEO  
PICTURE  
However, if you recorded to the HDD or a DVD-RAM and “Rec for  
High Speed Copy” was set to “Off” in the Setup menu (65), the  
aspect will remain 16:9.  
- - -  
007  
008  
3 Press [3, 4, 2, 1] to select the title and press  
[OK].  
It may be possible to adjust the display mode on the TV. Refer to  
your television’s operating instructions.  
You can also select titles with the numbered buttons.  
Preparation  
e.g.,  
[HDD]  
[RAM] [-R] [-R]DL] [-RW‹V›] [+R]  
Turn on the television and select the appropriate video input to suit  
the connections to this unit.  
[+R]DL] [+RW] [-RW‹VR›]  
5:  
15:  
115:  
[0] [0] [5]  
[0] [1] [5]  
[1] [1] [5]  
5:  
15:  
[0] [5]  
[1] [5]  
Turn on this unit.  
1 Press [DRIVE SELECT] to select the  
HDD or DVD drive.  
To show other pages  
The HDD or DVD indicator lights up on the unit’s display.  
It is possible to watch playback from one drive while  
recording on another (editing is not possible).  
Press [3, 4, 2, 1] to select “Previous” or “Next” and press  
[OK]. (Thumbnail Display only)  
You can also press [:, 9] to show other pages.  
2
If you selected the DVD drive  
To exit the screen  
Press [< OPEN/CLOSE] on the main  
Press [DIRECT NAVIGATOR].  
unit to open the tray and insert a disc.  
Press the button again to close the tray.  
Direct Navigator screen icons  
When using 8 cm DVD-RAM, or 8 cm DVD-R, remove the  
disc from the cartridge.  
[
Currently recording.  
Cartridge disc  
Title protected.  
Insert label-up.  
Insert label-up with the  
arrow facing in.  
Title that was not recorded due to recording  
protection (Digital broadcasts etc.)  
Title cannot be played  
[When copying a title to the HDD, or when data is  
damaged etc.]  
t
Titles that have been rerouted to the HDD  
Insert fully.  
Automatic drive select function (24)  
(33, Relief Recording)  
Title with “One time only recording” restriction  
(84, CPRM)  
3 Press [1] (PLAY).  
Title recorded using a different encoding system  
(NTSC)  
(PAL)  
[HDD] [RAM] [-R] [-R]DL] [-RW‹V›] [+R] [+R]DL] [+RW] [-RW‹VR›]  
Play starts from the most recently recorded title.  
[DVD-V] [CD] [VCD] and MP3  
from that of the TV system currently selected on the  
unit.  
Alter the “TV System” setting on this unit to suit  
Play starts from the beginning of the disc.  
DivX  
(72).  
DivX Menu screen appears (38).  
When using cartridge discs with the write-protect tab in the  
protect position (60), play automatically starts when  
inserted in the unit.  
RQT8859  
34  
When a menu screen appears on the television  
[DVD-V]  
Press [3, 4, 2, 1] to select the item and press [OK].  
Some items can also be selected using the numbered buttons.  
If “ENTER” appears on the screen, press [OK].  
[VCD]  
Press the numbered buttons to select the item.  
e.g.,  
5:  
[0] [5]  
15:  
[1] [5]  
s
c
To return to the menu screen  
[DVD-V] Press [DIRECT NAVIGATOR].  
is  
d
y
You can also return to the menu screen with the following steps.  
1
2
Press [OPTION].  
Press [3, 4] to select “Top Menu” or “Menu” and press [OK].  
-onl  
y
[VCD] Press [RETURN].  
pla  
ng  
[Note]  
i
y
When recording while the “TV System” is set to “PAL”, discs recorded in NTSC format cannot be played. To play, change the “TV System” to  
“NTSC” in the Setup menu (72).  
/Pla  
It is not possible to play continuously from one side of a double sided disc to the other. You will need to eject the disc and turn it over.  
Depending on the disc, it may take time for the menu screen, pictures, sound, etc. to start.  
Discs continue to rotate while menus are displayed. Press [] when you have finished playback to protect the unit’s motor, your television screen  
and so on.  
ts  
n
nte  
o
c
The producer of the disc can control how discs are played. So you may not always be able to control play as described in these operating  
instructions. Read the disc’s instructions carefully.  
When playing back a title recorded on the HDD, ensure that you match the “TV System” setting to the recorded title (72).  
o
de  
i
v
d
e
d
r
Operations during play  
o
c
e
Press [].  
The stopped position is memorized.  
r
Stop  
ing  
y
Resume play function  
Press [1] (PLAY) to restart from this position.  
a
l
P
Stopped position  
If [] is pressed several times, the position is cleared.  
The position is cleared if the tray is opened.  
[CD] [VCD] and MP3/DivX :The position is cleared if the unit is turned off.  
Press [;].  
Pause  
Press [;] again or [1] (PLAY) to restart play.  
Press [6] or [5].  
The speed increases up to 5 steps. ([+R] [+R]DL] [+RW] up to 3 steps)  
Press [1] (PLAY) to restart play.  
Search  
Audio is heard during first level search forward.  
[CD] and MP3 : Audio is heard during all levels of search.  
DivX : Audio is not heard during all levels of search.  
Depending on the disc, Search may not be possible.  
During play or while paused, press [:] or [9].  
Skip to the title, chapter or track you want to play.  
Skip  
Each press increases the number of skips.  
DivX : Press [:] to return to the beginning of the title currently playing.  
Press the numbered buttons.  
Starting from a selected  
title  
Play starts from the selected title, chapter or track.  
[HDD]  
e.g., 5: [0] [0] [5]  
15: [0] [1] [5]  
MP3 and JPEG  
e.g., 5: [0] [0] [0] [5]  
15: [0] [0] [1] [5]  
Other discs  
Input a 2-digit number  
e.g., 5: [0] [5]  
15: [1] [5]  
This works only when stopped (right, Screen saver is displayed on the  
television.) with some discs.  
[VCD] (with playback control)  
If you press the numbered buttons while stopped (the above screen saver is displayed on the  
television) you can cancel PBC. (Elapsed play time appears on the unit’s display.)  
Press and hold [1] (PLAY/a1.3).  
Play speed is quicker than normal.  
Quick View  
[HDD] [RAM]  
RQT8859  
Press again to return to normal speed.  
(Continued on the next page)  
35  
Playing recorded video contents/Playing play-only discs  
Refer to the control reference on page 34.  
Operations during play  
(continued)  
While paused, press [6] or [5].  
The speed increases up to 5 steps.  
Press [1] (PLAY) to restart play.  
Slow-motion  
[HDD] [RAM] [-R] [-R]DL] [-RW‹V›] [+R]  
[+R]DL] [+RW] [DVD-V]  
[VCD] Forward direction [5] only.  
[-RW‹VR›] [VCD]  
The unit will pause if slow-motion play is continued for approximately 5 minutes  
(excluding [DVD-V] [VCD]).  
While paused, press [2] (2;) or [1] (;1).  
Each press shows the next frame.  
Press and hold to change in succession forward or backward.  
Press [1] (PLAY) to restart play.  
Frame-by-frame  
[HDD] [RAM] [-R] [-R]DL] [-RW‹V›] [+R]  
[+R]DL] [+RW] [DVD-V]  
[-RW‹VR›] [VCD]  
[VCD] Forward direction [1] (;1) only.  
1 Press [TIME SLIP].  
2 Press [3, 4] to select the time  
Skipping the specified  
time (Time Slip)  
-
5 min  
This automatically  
disappears after  
approximately 5  
and press [OK].  
[HDD] [RAM] [-R] [-R]DL] [-RW‹V›] [+R]  
[+R]DL] [+RW] [-RW‹VR›]  
Play skips the specified time.  
Each time you press [3, 4], the time  
increases [3] or decreases [4] by 1 minute  
intervals. (Press and hold for 10-minute  
intervals.)  
seconds. To show the  
screen again press  
[TIME SLIP] again.  
(This function does not work with  
finalised discs.)  
Press [MANUAL SKIP].  
Each time you press, skip approx. 30 seconds forward.  
Manual Skip  
[HDD] [RAM] [-R] [-R]DL] [-RW‹V›] [+R]  
[+R]DL] [+RW] [-RW‹VR›]  
(This function does not work with  
finalised discs.)  
Press [CREATE CHAPTER].  
Chapters are divided at the point pressed.  
Press [:, 9] to skip to the start of a chapter.  
Create Chapter  
(44, Title/Chapter)  
[HDD] [RAM]  
Changing audio during play  
(Analogue broadcast only)  
Press [AUDIO].  
[HDD] [RAM] [-RW‹VR›] [VCD] and DivX  
LR>L>R  
[DVD-V]  
You can change the audio channel number each time you press the  
button. This allows you to change things like the soundtrack  
language (42, Soundtrack).  
^---------------}  
HDD  
PLAY  
1 ENG  
Î Digital 3/2.1ch  
Soundtrack  
e.g., English is selected.  
e.g., “L R” is selected  
L R  
[Note]  
You cannot change the audio type in the following cases.  
When a DVD-R, DVD-R DL, DVD-RW (DVD-Video format), +R, +R DL or +RW disc is in the disc tray while DVD drive is selected.  
When the recording mode is XP and “Audio Mode for XP Recording” is set to “LPCM” (66).  
When “Rec for High Speed Copy” is set to “On” (The default setting is “On”. 65).  
RQT8859  
36  
Playing DivX discs, MP3 discs and still pictures (JPEG)  
Regarding DivX discs, MP3 discs and still pictures (JPEG)  
DivX  
[-R] [-R]DL] [CD]  
[CD] Compatible formats: ISO9660 level 1 or 2 (except for extended  
formats) and Joliet  
Playable  
discs  
[-R] [-R]DL] [CD]  
This unit is compatible with multi-session but reading or play of the  
disc may take time if there are a lot of sessions.  
Operation may take time to complete when there are many files  
(tracks) and/or folders (groups) and some files (tracks) may not  
display or be playable.  
File  
format  
DivX  
Files must have the extension  
“.DIVX”, “.divx”, “.AVI” or “.avi”.  
)
G
E
P
J
English alphabet and Arabic numerals are displayed correctly.  
Other characters may not be displayed correctly.  
The display order on this unit may differ from how the order is  
displayed on a computer.  
Depending on how you create the disc (writing software), files  
(tracks) and folders (groups) may not play in the order you  
numbered them.  
Number  
Maximum number of folders recognizable: 300 folders  
es(  
of folders (including the root folder)  
ur  
Maximum number of files recognizable§1: 200 files  
t
Number  
of files  
Support  
version  
Plays all versions of DivX video (including DivX 6) with  
standard playback of DivX media files.  
Certified to the DivX Home Theater Profile.  
Video  
lpic  
st  
d
n
This unit is not compatible with packet-write format.  
Depending on the recording conditions, the disc may not play.  
–Number of stream: Up to 1  
csa  
–Codec: DIV3, DIV4, DIVX, DV50  
–Picture size: 32 x 32 to 720 x 576  
–FPS (Frame Per Second): Up to 30 fps  
Audio  
–Number of stream: Up to 8  
–Format: MP3, MPEG, AC3  
[HDD] [RAM] [SD]  
Compatible formats: DCF§4 compliant (Content recorded on a  
digital camera, etc.)  
3dis  
§4 Design rule for Camera File system: unified standard  
established by Japan Electronics and Information Technology  
Industries Association (JEITA).  
MP  
cs,  
i
–Multi channel: AC3 is possible. MPEG multi is 2 ch  
conversion.  
d
vX  
GMC (Global Motion Compensation) is not supported.  
You can play MP3 and still pictures (JPEG) on this unit by  
making folders as shown below. However depending on how  
you create the disc (writing software), play may not be in the  
order you numbered the folders.  
MP3  
ngDi  
Playable  
discs  
[CD]  
y
a
l
[CD]  
File  
MP3  
Root  
Structure of MP3 folders  
cs/P  
format  
Files must have the extension “.mp3” or “.MP3”.  
(folder=group)  
001  
Prefix with 3-digit numbers  
in the order you want to play  
them.  
is  
d
y
Number  
Maximum number of folders (groups) recognizable:  
(file=track)  
001track.mp3  
002track.mp3  
003track.mp3  
of folders 300 folders (groups)  
(groups)  
(including the root folder)  
onl  
-
002 group  
y
Maximum number of files (tracks) recognizable§1  
3000 files (tracks)  
:
001track.mp3  
002track.mp3  
003track.mp3  
004track.mp3  
Number  
of files  
003 group  
pla  
(tracks)  
g
n
001track.mp3  
002track.mp3  
003track.mp3  
Order of play  
yi  
Bit rates  
32 kbps to 320 kbps  
Sampling 16 kHz/22.05 kHz/24 kHz/32 kHz/44.1kHz/48 kHz  
frequency  
/Pla  
s
t
[CD]  
n
e
Root  
Structures of still pictures  
Files inside a folder are displayed  
in the order they were updated or  
taken.  
ID3 tags  
not compatible  
P0000001.jpg  
P0000002.jpg  
ont  
If there is a large amount of still picture data etc. within a MP3 file,  
play may not be possible.  
002 Folder  
P0000003.jpg  
P0000004.jpg  
P0000005.jpg  
Still pictures (JPEG§2  
)
Playable  
discs and  
cards  
[HDD] [RAM] [CD] [SD]  
videoc  
003 Folder  
d
e
P0000006.jpg  
P0000007.jpg  
P0000008.jpg  
P0000009.jpg  
004 Folder  
d
File  
format  
File format: JPEG  
Files must have the extension “.jpg” or “.JPG”.  
cor  
P0000010.jpg  
P0000011.jpg  
P0000012.jpg  
Order of play  
Number  
of pixels  
Between 34k34 and 6144k4096  
(Sub sampling is 4:2:2 or 4:2:0)  
ingre  
y
a
l
P
Number  
of  
folders§3  
[CD] Maximum number of folders recognizable:300  
folders (including the root folder)  
[Note]  
You cannot playback DivX or still pictures (JPEG) while recording or  
copying.  
[HDD] [RAM] [SD] This unit can handle a maximum of  
300 folders (including higher folders)  
[CD] Maximum number of files recognizable§1:3000  
files  
Number  
of files§3  
[HDD] [RAM] [SD] This unit can handle a maximum of  
3000 files  
MOTION  
JPEG  
not supported  
§1 Total number of recognizable file including MP3, JPEG, DivX and  
other types of files is 4000.  
§2 It may take a few moments for still pictures to display.  
§3 When there are many files and/or folders, some files may not  
display or be playable.  
RQT8859  
37  
Playing DivX discs, MP3 discs and still pictures (JPEG)  
Playing DivX discs  
[-R] [-R]DL] [CD]  
You can play DVD-R, DVD-R DL and CD-R/CD-RW discs which  
contain DivX video contents that have been recorded on a computer.  
DVD  
TV  
Í
Í
VOL  
CH  
DRIVE  
SELECT  
AV  
Preparation  
Press [DRIVE SELECT] to select the DVD drive.  
DRIVE  
SELECT  
PAGE  
CH  
2 3  
4 5 6  
1
Numbered  
buttons  
1 Press [DIRECT NAVIGATOR].  
ANALOGUE  
CH  
8 9  
7
Folder1  
:
00025  
DivX Menu  
CD (DivX)  
G-Code  
DELETE  
INPUT  
0
SELECT  
No.  
001  
Name of Title  
Tree  
SKIP  
SLOW/SEARCH  
ABC.avi  
:, 9  
PAUSE  
PLAY/x1.3  
EXIT  
STOP  
1
STATUS  
STATUS  
Page  
001/001  
Total Title : 001  
I
OK  
RETURN  
DIRECT  
NAVIGATOR  
FUNCTION  
MENU  
Files are treated as titles.  
OK  
When the MP3 or JPEG Menu is displayed, perform steps  
1–4 in “To select file type” on the left column selecting “DivX”  
in step 4 to change the playback mode.  
3,4,2,1  
OPTION  
RETURN  
OK  
RETURN  
“Green”  
CREATE  
CHAPTER  
DISPLAY  
AUDIO  
REC  
MANUAL SKIP  
OPTION  
2 Press [3, 4] to select the title and  
REC MODE TIME SLIP PROG/CHECK  
press [OK].  
Play starts on the selected title.  
You can also select the title with the numbered buttons.  
Selecting file type to play  
[CD]  
e.g.,  
5:  
[0] [0] [5]  
15:  
[0] [1] [5]  
You can play CD-R/CD-RW discs which contain MP3 files, DivX  
video contents or still pictures that have been recorded on a  
computer.  
To stop playing  
Press [].  
The screen shown below is displayed when you insert a disc  
To show other pages  
Press [:, 9].  
containing DivX video contents, MP3 files and still pictures (JPEG).  
e.g.,  
To exit the screen  
Press [DIRECT NAVIGATOR].  
Play mode is set to DivX.  
To play another type of file,  
select the file type  
[Note]  
from ''Playback'' in FUNCTION MENU.  
Picture sizes set at the recording time may prevent the unit from  
showing pictures in the adequate aspect. You may be able to  
adjust the aspect through the TV.  
Successive play is not possible.  
Playback is not possible if recording is performed on the HDD  
drive.  
When playing the file displayed on the screen  
Press [OK].  
When you want to play files other than the one displayed on the  
screen  
Follow the steps below.  
To select file type  
Using the tree screen to find a folder  
1 Press [RETURN].  
2 Press [FUNCTION MENU].  
FUNCTION MENU  
1 While the file list is displayed  
Press [1] while a title is highlighted to display  
the tree screen.  
CD(DivX/MP3/JPEG)  
Play Mode : DivX  
Playback  
Recording  
F: Selected folder no./Total folder no. including DivX title.  
Copy  
Folder  
DivX Menu  
CD (DivX)  
To Others  
OK  
F
1/21  
RETURN  
12.02.2004  
Image001  
Image002  
Image003  
Image004  
Image005  
Image006  
Image007  
Image008  
Image009  
Image010  
DATA1  
3 Press [3, 4] to select “Playback” and press  
[OK].  
You cannot select  
folders that contain no  
compatible files.  
DATA2  
OK  
RETURN  
Playback  
Select file type.  
DivX  
2 Press [  
3
,
4] to select a folder and press [OK].  
MP3  
The file list for the folder appears.  
JPEG  
To return to the previous screen  
Press [RETURN].  
4 Press [3, 4] to select playback mode and press  
[OK].  
If “DivX” is selected: Go to “Playing DivX discs” step 2 in the right  
column.  
If “MP3” is selected: Go to “Playing MP3 discs” step 2  
on page 39.  
If “JPEG” is selected: Go to “Playing still pictures” step 4 on page  
40.  
RQT8859  
38  
Regarding DivX VOD content  
Playing MP3 discs  
[CD]  
You can play CD-R/CD-RW discs which contain MP3 files that have  
been recorded on a computer.  
DivX Video-on-Demand (VOD) content is encrypted for copyright  
protection. In order to play DivX VOD content on this unit, you first  
need to register the unit.  
Follow the on line instructions for purchasing DivX VOD content to  
enter the unit’s registration code and register the unit. For more  
Preparation  
Press [DRIVE SELECT] to select the DVD drive.  
)
G
E
Display the unit’s registration code.  
(68, “DivX Registration” in “Others” tab)  
P
J
1 Press [DIRECT NAVIGATOR].  
DivX Registration  
Setup  
es(  
Selected group  
ur  
t
DivX (R) Video On Demand  
No.  
Group  
My favorite  
MP3 Menu  
1
Total  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
:
G: Group No.  
G
1
Tuning  
Track  
Tree  
T
1
T: Track No. in the group  
TOTAL: Track No./Total  
tracks in all groups  
001 Both Ends Freezing  
TOTAL  
8 alphanumeric  
characters  
Your registration code is : XXXXXXXX  
lpic  
002 Lady Starfish  
003 Life on Jupiter  
004 Metal Glue  
005 Paint It Yellow  
006 Pyjamamama  
007 Shrimps from Mars  
008 Starperson  
1/111  
Disc  
st  
Picture  
Sound  
Display  
Number  
d
n
0
9
Prev.  
Next  
8
SELECT  
OK  
9
10  
009 Velvet Cuppermine  
010 Ziggy Starfish  
csa  
Connection  
Others  
OK  
RETURN  
Page 001/024  
RETURN  
3dis  
Files are treated as tracks and folders are treated as groups.  
After playing DivX VOD content for the first time, another  
registration code is then displayed in “DivX Registration”. Do not  
use this registration code to purchase DivX VOD content. If you  
use this code to purchase DivX VOD content, and then play the  
content on this unit, you will no longer be able to play any content  
that you purchased using the previous code.  
If you purchase DivX VOD content using a registration code  
different from this unit’s code, you will not be able to play this  
content. (“Authorisation Error.” is displayed.)  
When the DivX or JPEG Menu is displayed, perform steps 1–4 in  
To select file type” on page 38 selecting “MP3” in step 4 to change  
the playback mode.  
MP  
cs,  
i
d
2 Press [3, 4] to select the track and  
vX  
press [OK].  
Play starts on the selected track.  
0” indicates the track currently playing.  
You can also select the track with the numbered buttons.  
ngDi  
y
a
l
e.g.,  
5:  
[0] [0] [0] [5]  
P
15:  
[0] [0] [1] [5]  
Regarding DivX content that can only be played a set number of  
times  
Some DivX VOD content can only be played a set number of times.  
When you play this content, the remaining number of plays is  
displayed. You cannot play this content when the number of  
remaining plays is zero. (“Rental Expired” is displayed.)  
To stop playing  
Press [].  
To show other pages  
Press [:, 9].  
To exit the screen  
Press [DIRECT NAVIGATOR].  
When playing this content  
The number of remaining plays is reduced by one if  
–you press [Í DVD].  
–you press [].  
Using the tree screen to find a group  
–you press [DIRECT NAVIGATOR].  
–you press [:] or [6, 5] etc. and arrive at another content  
or the start of the content being played.  
–timer recording starts on the HDD.  
–you press [DRIVE SELECT] to change the drive.  
Resume functions do not work.  
1 While the file list is displayed  
Press [1] while a track is highlighted to display  
the tree screen.  
Selected group No. /Total groups  
If the group has no track, “– –” is displayed as group number.  
MP3 Menu  
Tree  
G
T
TOTAL  
8
14  
MP3 music  
G
7/25  
001 My favorite  
001 Brazilian pops  
002 Chinese pops  
003 Czech pops  
004 Hungarian pops  
005 Liner notes  
40/111  
Number  
You cannot select groups  
that contain no compatible  
files.  
0
9
006 Japanese pops  
007 Mexican pops  
008 Philippine pops  
009 Swedish pops  
001 Momoko  
002 Standard number  
001 Piano solo  
002 Vocal  
SELECT  
OK  
RETURN  
2 Press [3, 4, 2, 1] to select a group and press  
[OK].  
The file list for the group appears.  
To return to the previous screen  
Press [RETURN].  
RQT8859  
39  
Playing DivX discs, MP3 discs and still pictures (JPEG)  
Refer to the control reference on page 38.  
3 Press [3, 4, 2, 1] to select the  
Playing still pictures  
album and press [OK].  
DIRECT NAVIGATOR Picture (JPEG) View  
[HDD] [RAM] [CD] [SD]  
e.g., HDD  
PICTURE  
HDD  
Album Name 103__DVD  
0001  
0002  
0006  
----  
0003  
0007  
----  
0004  
0008  
----  
You can playback still pictures recorded onto a CD-R/CD-RW on a  
PC.  
You can use SD Cards with capacities from 8 MB to 4 GB (7).  
You cannot playback still pictures while recording or copying.  
Inserting, Removing the SD Card (13)  
0005  
0009  
Page 001/001  
Previous  
Next  
OK  
Select  
OPTION  
RETURN  
You can also select album with the numbered buttons.  
e.g.,  
While stopped put the card in the slot, and the menu (below)  
is automatically displayed.  
Press [3, 4] to select “Album View” and then press [OK] to  
display the Album View screen shown in step 2.  
SD Card  
5:  
[0] [0] [5]  
15: [0] [1] [5]  
115: [1] [1] [5]  
Press [2, 1] to select the previous or next album.  
4 Press [3, 4, 2, 1] to select the still  
picture and press [OK].  
Album View  
Copy Pictures (JPEG)  
Copy Video (MPEG2)  
SELECT  
RETURN  
OK  
You can also select still pictures with the numbered buttons.  
e.g.,  
5:  
[0] [0] [0] [5]  
115: [0] [1] [1] [5]  
15: [0] [0] [1] [5]  
1115: [1] [1] [1] [5]  
Press [2, 1] to display the previous or next still picture.  
Useful functions during still picture play (41)  
1 Press [DRIVE SELECT] to select the  
HDD, DVD or SD drive.  
To return to the Album View screen or Picture (JPEG) View  
The indicator lights up on the unit’s display.  
screen  
Press [RETURN].  
To exit the screen  
Press [DIRECT NAVIGATOR].  
2 Press [DIRECT NAVIGATOR].  
[HDD] [RAM] [SD]  
DIRECT NAVIGATOR Album View  
HDD  
Album View screen  
VIDEO  
PICTURE  
- - -  
001  
002  
Recording date of the  
first picture in the  
1. 1. 06 Total  
Date: 1. 1.2006  
5
1. 2. 06 Total  
Date: 1. 2.2006  
3
- - -  
- - -  
- - -  
album/number of  
pictures/album name.  
Page 01/01  
OPTION  
Previous  
Next  
OK  
Press OK to show  
pictures.  
Slide Show  
RETURN  
Depending on the digital camera, the editing software on the  
PC etc., the information about the recording date may not be  
displayed. In this case, the date will appear as [--.--.--].  
[HDD] [RAM] If “VIDEO” is selected, press the “Green” button to  
select “PICTURE”.  
[CD]  
JPEG Menu  
CD(JPEG)  
Picture (JPEG) View  
103__DVD  
Picture (JPEG) View  
screen  
Folder  
0001  
0005  
0009  
0002  
0003  
0007  
----  
0004  
0008  
----  
0006  
----  
Page 001/001  
Previous  
Next  
OK  
RETURN  
(Go to step 4)  
When the DivX or MP3 Menu is displayed, perform steps 1–4  
in “To select file type” on page 38 selecting “JPEG” in step 4 to  
change the playback mode.  
Direct Navigator screen icons  
Picture and folder protected.  
To show other pages  
Press [3, 4, 2, 1] to select “Previous” or “Next” and press  
[OK].  
You can also press [:, 9] to show other pages.  
To select the still pictures in another folder (41)  
RQT8859  
40  
Useful functions during still picture play  
You can display still pictures one by one at a constant interval.  
Start Slide Show  
[HDD] [RAM] [SD]  
1 While the Album View screen is displayed  
Slide Show Setting  
)
Press [3, 4, 2, 1] to select the album.  
2 Press [1] (PLAY).  
G
E
P
J
You can also start Slide Show with the following steps.  
Start Slide Show  
Slide Show Setting  
1
While the Album View screen is displayed  
es(  
Press [3, 4, 2, 1] to select the desired album and press [OPTION].  
Press [3, 4] to select “Start Slide Show” and press [OK].  
ur  
t
2
[CD]  
lpic  
1 While the Picture (JPEG) View screen is displayed  
Press [3, 4, 2, 1] to select “Folder” and press [OPTION].  
2 Press [3, 4] to select “Start Slide Show” and press [OK].  
st  
d
n
To change the display interval  
csa  
1
2
3
Press [3, 4] to select “Slide Show Setting” in step 2 and press [OK].  
Press [3, 4] to select “Display interval”.  
Press [2, 1] to select the desired interval (0–30 seconds) and press [OK].  
3dis  
Repeat Play  
MP  
1
2
3
Press [3, 4] to select “Slide Show Setting” in step 2 and press [OK].  
Press [3, 4] to select “Repeat Play”.  
Press [2, 1] to select “On” or “Off” and press [OK].  
cs,  
i
d
vX  
1 While playing  
Rotate  
Rotate RIGHT  
Press [OPTION].  
Rotate LEFT  
OK  
2 Press [3, 4] to select “Rotate RIGHT” or “Rotate LEFT” and  
ngDi  
RETURN  
y
press [OK].  
Rotation information will not be stored.  
[CD] Still pictures  
a
l
P
–When disc or album is protected  
–When played on other equipment  
–When copying pictures  
If you remove the SD Card while the DIRECT NAVIGATOR screen is displayed, picture rotation  
information may not be properly stored. Remove the SD Card after you exit the DIRECT NAVIGATOR  
screen.  
1 While playing  
Zoom in  
Zoom out  
Rotate RIGHT  
Press [OPTION].  
Rotate LEFT  
Zoom in  
2 Press [3, 4] to select “Zoom in” and press [OK].  
To return the picture to its original size, press [3, 4] to select “Zoom out” in step 2 and  
press [OK].  
OK  
RETURN  
When zooming in, the picture may be cut off.  
The enlargement information will not be stored.  
The “Zoom in/Zoom out” function is only available for still pictures smaller than  
640 a 480 pixels.  
While playing  
e.g., HDD  
Press [STATUS ] twice.  
Properties  
18:53:50 11.10.  
Folder - Picture No. 103 - 0006  
Date  
1. 1. 2005  
No.  
3 / 9  
To exit the picture properties screen  
Shooting date  
Press [STATUS ].  
To select the still pictures in another folder  
[RAM] [SD] (7, Structure of folders displayed by this unit)  
To switch to another higher folder  
[CD]  
1 While the Picture (JPEG) View screen is displayed  
(Only if there is a multiple number of higher folders recognizable)  
1 While the Album View screen is displayed  
Press [OPTION].  
Press [3, 4, 2, 1] to select “Folder” and press [OK].  
2 Press [3, 4] to select the folder and press [OK].  
JPEG Menu  
CD(JPEG)  
JPEG Menu  
CD(JPEG)  
Picture (JPEG) View  
Folder  
2 Press [3, 4] to select “Select Folder” and press [OK].  
Folder  
103__DVD  
F
1/3  
0001  
----  
----  
0002  
----  
----  
0003  
----  
0004  
----  
021216_0026  
103_DVD  
Select Folder  
104_DVD  
105_DVD  
Select folder to access.  
\DCIM  
----  
----  
Press OK to set.  
SELECT  
Page 001/001  
Previous  
Next  
OK  
OK  
RETURN  
OK  
OPTION  
RETURN  
RETURN  
3 Press [2, 1] to select the higher folder and press [OK].  
RQT8859  
41  
Using on-screen menus/Status message  
Subtitle§  
[DVD-V]  
Turn the subtitle on/off and select the language (below,  
Language).  
[HDD] [RAM] [-R] [-R]DL] [-RW‹V›] [+R] [+R]DL] [+RW] [-RW‹VR›] (Only  
discs that contain subtitle on/off information)  
Turn the subtitle on/off.  
Subtitle on/off information cannot be recorded using this unit.  
DivX  
Turn the subtitle on/off and select the subtitle number.  
Subtitle numbers are displayed even if there are not multiple  
subtitles.  
DVD  
TV  
Í
Í
VOL  
CH  
DRIVE  
SELECT  
AV  
PAGE  
CH  
2 3  
1
4 5 6  
ANALOGUE  
CH  
8 9  
0
7
G-Code  
DELETE  
INPUT  
SELECT  
SKIP  
SLOW/SEARCH  
Angle§ [DVD-V]  
Change the number to select an angle.  
Audio channel [HDD] [RAM] [-RW‹VR›] [VCD] and DivX  
(36, Changing audio during play)  
Source Select (DivX)  
PAUSE  
PLAY/x1.3  
EXIT  
STOP  
STATUS  
STATUS  
I
OK  
Automatic: The constructing method of the DivX contents  
is automatically distinguished and output.  
Interlace: Select when the disc contents were recorded  
using interlace.  
3,4,2,1  
OPTION  
RETURN  
OK  
CREATE  
DISPLAY  
CHAPTER  
AUDIO  
REC  
MANUAL SKIP  
DISPLAY  
REC MODE TIME SLIP PROG/CHECK  
Progressive: Select when the disc contents were recorded  
using progressive.  
PBC (Playback control) (85) [VCD]  
Indicates whether menu play (playback control) is on or off.  
§ With some discs, you may only be able to make changes using the  
menus (35) on the disc.  
The display changes according to the disc content. You cannot  
change when there is no recording.  
Audio attribute  
LPCM/ÎDigital/DTS/MPEG:  
k (kHz):  
Using on-screen menus  
Signal type  
Sampling frequency  
Number of bits  
Number of channels  
b (bit):  
ch (channel):  
Common procedures  
Language  
1 Press [DISPLAY].  
ENG: English  
FRA: French  
DEU: German  
ITA: Italian  
ESP: Spanish  
NLD: Dutch  
DAN: Danish  
THA: Thai  
Disc  
Î Digital 2/0 ch  
1
Soundtrack  
Subtitle  
POR: Portuguese  
RUS: Russian  
JPN: Japanese  
CHI: Chinese  
KOR: Korean  
POL: Polish  
CES: Czech  
SLK: Slovak  
HUN: Hungarian  
FIN: Finnish  
Play  
Off  
Picture  
Sound  
Other  
L R  
Audio channel  
Menu  
Item  
Setting  
SVE: Swedish  
NOR: Norwegian  
MAL: Malay  
¢:  
Others  
VIE: Vietnamese  
Depending on the condition of the unit (playing, stopped,  
etc.) and disc contents, there are some items that you  
cannot select or change.  
2 Press [3, 4] to select the menu and  
Play menu—Change the play sequence  
press [1].  
This function works only when the elapsed play time is displayed.  
Select the item for repeat play. Depending on the disc, the items that  
can be selected will differ.  
3 Press [3, 4] to select the item and  
press [1].  
Repeat Play  
4 Press [3, 4] to select the setting.  
All  
Chapter  
[CD][VCD]  
Some items can be changed by pressing [OK].  
[HDD] [RAM] [-R][-R]DL] [-RW‹V›] [+R] [+R]DL]  
[+RW] [DVD-V] [-RW‹VR›]  
MP3  
[HDD] [RAM] [-RW‹VR›]  
[HDD] [RAM] [-R] [-R]DL] [-RW‹V›] [+R] [+R]DL]  
[+RW] [DVD-V] [-RW‹VR›]  
[CD] [VCD] and MP3  
Group  
PL (Playlist)  
Title  
To clear the on-screen menus  
Press [DISPLAY].  
Disc menu—Setting the disc content  
Track  
Soundtrack§  
Select “Off” to cancel.  
[HDD] [RAM] [-R] [-R]DL] [-RW‹V›] [+R] [+R]DL] [+RW] [-RW‹VR›]  
The disc’s audio attributes appear.  
[DVD-V]  
Select the audio and language (right, Audio attribute,  
Language).  
DivX  
Select the soundtrack number.  
Soundtrack numbers are displayed even when there is only  
one audio type.  
RQT8859  
42  
Picture menu—Change the picture quality  
Dialog Enhancer  
[HDD] [RAM] [-R][-R]DL] [-RW‹V›] [+R] [+R]DL] [+RW] [DVD-V] [-RW‹VR›]  
and DivX  
Playback NR  
(Dolby Digital, 3-channel or over only, including a centre channel)  
Reduces noise and picture degradation.  
Progressive§ (85)  
The volume of the centre channel is raised to make dialogue  
easier to hear.  
e
Select “On” to enable progressive output.  
Select “Off” if the picture is stretched horizontally.  
g
a
Other menu—Change the display position  
Position  
Transfer§ [When “Progressive” (above) is set to “On”.]  
mes  
s
Select the method of conversion for progressive output to suit  
the type of title being played (84, Film and video).  
u
t
1–5: The higher the setting the lower the on-screen menu  
moves.  
a
/St  
When the output signal is PAL  
(When the tray is opened, the setting will return to “Auto”.)  
s
u
n
Auto:  
Video:  
Film:  
Automatically detects the film and video  
content, and appropriately converts it.  
Select when using “Auto”, and the content is  
distorted.  
Select this if the edges of  
the film content appear  
me  
Status messages  
During playback or recording  
en  
re  
c
s
-
Press [STATUS ].  
n
The display changes each time you press the button.  
o
g
jagged or rough when  
“Auto” is selected.  
However, if the video  
in  
Selected drive status/type of disc  
HDD  
s
U
The remaining time appears here while stopped.  
Recording or play status/input channel  
PLAY  
content is distorted as  
shown in the illustration to the right, then select  
“Auto”.  
REC  
Channel (Analogue broadcast)  
The name of the station (Digital broadcast).  
Selected audio type  
ABC  
When the output signal is NTSC  
L R  
Recording drive/Copy progress indicator  
DVD REC  
Auto1  
(normal):  
Auto2:  
Automatically detects the film and video  
content, and appropriately converts it.  
In addition to “Auto1”, automatically detects  
film contents with different frame rates and  
appropriately converts it.  
Select when using “Auto1” and “Auto2”, and  
the content is distorted.  
Title number and elapsed time during play/  
Recording mode  
Available recording time and  
recording mode  
Video:  
Date and time  
AV-in NR (Only when AV1, AV2, AV3, AV4 or DV is selected)  
π
Remain  
18:53:50 11.10.  
13:50 XP  
Reduces video tape noise while copying.  
π T1 0:05.14 XP π T2 0:00.10 XP  
Automatic: Noise reduction only works on picture input from  
Title number and elapsed time during  
a video tape.  
recording/Recording mode  
On:  
Off:  
Noise reduction works for input video.  
Noise reduction is off. You can record the input  
signal as it is.  
No display  
§ Only when you have set “Progressive” to “On” in the Setup menu  
(21).  
Sound menu—Change the sound effect  
DVB Multi Audio  
[Digital channel only]  
If more than one audio channel is output, you can set the  
desired channel before recording.  
DVB Multi Audio cannot be selected during playback or  
recording.  
Depending on the broadcast, the items that can be selected  
will differ.  
English German Italian  
Spanish Original§  
French  
§ “Original” is displayed when a broadcast is only available in  
the original language.  
V.S.S.  
[HDD] [RAM] [-R][-R]DL] [-RW‹V›] [+R] [+R]DL] [+RW] [DVD-V] [-RW‹VR›]  
(Dolby Digital, MPEG, 2-channel or over only)  
Enjoy a surround-like effect if you are using two front speakers  
only.  
Turn V.S.S. off if it causes distortion. (Check the surround  
function on the connected equipment.)  
V.S.S. does not work for bilingual recordings.  
RQT8859  
43  
Editing titles/chapters  
DVD  
TV  
Í
Í
1
2
During play or while stopped  
VOL  
CH  
DRIVE  
SELECT  
AV  
DRIVE  
SELECT  
Press [DIRECT NAVIGATOR].  
[HDD] [RAM]  
PAGE  
CH  
2 3  
1
4 5 6  
Press the “Red” button to select  
“VIDEO”.  
ANALOGUE  
CH  
8 9  
0
7
G-Code  
DELETE  
INPUT  
SELECT  
SKIP  
3 Press [3, 4, 2, 1] to select the title.  
DIRECT NAVIGATOR Title View  
VIDEO  
PICTURE  
SLOW/SEARCH  
:, 9  
;
1
Title View screen  
HDD  
PAUSE  
PLAY/x1.3  
EXIT  
STOP  
- - -  
007  
008  
STATUS  
ARD 10.10. FRI  
- - -  
ARD 11.10. SAT  
- - -  
I
- - -  
DIRECT  
NAVIGATOR  
OK  
Previous  
Next  
Page 02/02  
3,4,2,1  
OK  
Select Previous  
Next  
OPTION  
RETURN  
OK  
OPTION  
RETURN  
RETURN  
To show other pages  
Press [3, 4, 2, 1] to select “Previous” or “Next” and  
press [OK].  
You can also press [:, 9] to show other pages.  
Multiple editing  
OPTION  
“Red”  
CREATE  
CHAPTER  
DISPLAY  
AUDIO  
REC  
MANUAL SKIP  
[HDD] [RAM] [-R] [-R]DL] [-RW‹V›] [+R] [+R]DL] [+RW] [-RW‹VR›]  
(You cannot edit finalised discs.)  
Select with [3, 4, 2, 1] and press [;]. (Repeat.)  
A check mark appears. Press [;] again to cancel.  
Title/Chapter  
Programmes are recorded as a single title consisting of one  
chapter.  
4
5
Press [OPTION].  
Title  
Chapter  
Press [3,  
4] to select the operation  
and press [OK].  
Start  
End  
If you select “Edit”, press [3, 4] to select the operation and  
press [OK]. (45)  
[HDD] [RAM] You can divide a title into multiple chapters. Each  
section between the division points becomes a chapter.  
(36, 45, Create Chapter)  
Enter Name  
Set up Protection  
Title  
Cancel Protection  
Refer to “Title  
operations”  
(45).  
Partial Delete  
Delete  
Chapter  
Chapter  
Chapter  
Chapter  
Change Thumbnail  
Properties  
Edit  
Divide Title  
[HDD] [RAM] You can change the order of chapters and create a  
Chapter View  
Table Display  
Album View  
playlist (46).  
Switching the Direct Navigator  
appearance 34  
The maximum number of items on a disc:  
Playing still pictures 40, step 3  
[HDD]  
–Titles:  
–Chapters: Approx. 1000 per title  
(Depends on the state of recording.)  
[RAM] [-R] [-R]DL] [-RW‹V›] [+R] [+R]DL] [+RW]  
500  
If you select “Chapter View”  
6
Press [  
3
,
4
,
2
,
1
] to select the chapter.  
–Titles:  
99 ([+R] [+R]DL] [+RW] 49 titles)  
To start play Press [OK].  
–Chapters:  
Approx. 1000 ([+R] [+R]DL] [+RW] Approx. 254)  
(Depends on the state of recording.)  
To edit Step 7.  
DIRECT NAVIGATOR Chapter View  
Chapter View screen  
VIDEO  
[Note]  
HDD  
008 ARD 11.10. SAT  
Once deleted, divided or partially deleted, recorded content cannot  
be restored to its original state. Make certain before proceeding.  
You cannot edit during recording or copying, etc.  
Restricted recording information remains even after editing (e.g.  
dividing a title etc).  
001  
---  
---  
---  
---  
---  
---  
---  
---  
---  
---  
0:31.24  
---  
To show other pages/Multiple editing (above)  
[+R] [+R]DL] Each time you edit a title the information is saved to the  
free space on the disc. If you do this numerous times, the amount  
of free space decreases.  
7
Press [OPTION], then [  
the operation and press [OK].  
3
,
4] to select  
We recommend that you edit on the HDD and then copy to disc.  
Delete Chapter  
Editing titles/chapters and playing  
chapters  
You can modify (remove unnecessary parts, divide, etc.) recorded  
programmes.  
Create Chapter  
Refer to “Chapter  
operations” (45).  
Combine Chapters  
Title View  
Preparation  
You can go back to Title View.  
Turn on the television and select the appropriate video input to suit  
the connection to this unit.  
Turn the unit on.  
Press [DRIVE SELECT] to select the drive containing the recorded  
title to be edited.  
[RAM] Release protection (60).  
To return to the previous screen  
Press [RETURN].  
To exit the screen  
Press [DIRECT NAVIGATOR].  
RQT8859  
44  
Title operations  
After performing steps 1–5 (44)  
Delete§  
Press [2, 1] to select “Delete” and press [OK].  
Once deleted, the recorded contents are lost and cannot be restored. Make certain before proceeding.  
The available recording space on DVD-R, DVD-R DL, +R or +R DL does not increase when you delete titles.  
Available recording space on DVD-RW (DVD-Video format) and +RW increases only when the last recorded  
title is deleted. It does not increase if other titles are deleted.  
[HDD] [RAM] [-R] [-R]DL] [-RW‹V›]  
[+R] [+R]DL] [+RW]  
s
er  
t
Information (e.g., time and date) is shown.  
Press [OK] to exit the screen.  
Properties  
Properties  
p
a
Dinosaur  
[HDD] [RAM] [-R] [-R]DL] [-RW‹V›]  
[+R] [+R]DL] [+RW] [-RW‹VR›]  
h
No.  
026  
Time  
12:19  
c
/
Date 11.10.2006 MON Rec time 0:30 (SP)  
Name ARD  
es  
l
t
i
You can give names to recorded titles.  
(59, Entering text)  
Enter Name  
t
g
[HDD] [RAM] [-R] [-R]DL] [-RW‹V›]  
[+R] [+R]DL] [+RW]  
in  
it  
Set up Protection§  
If set, this will protect the title from accidental deletion.  
Ed  
DIRECT NAVIGATOR Title V  
HDD  
Press [2, 1] to select “Yes” and press [OK].  
The lock symbol appears when the title is protected.  
Cancel Protection§  
007  
008  
[HDD] [RAM] [+R] [+R]DL] [+RW]  
ARD 10.10. FRI  
ARD 11.10.  
VIDEO  
You can remove unnecessary part of the recording.  
DIRECT NAVIGATOR Partial Delete  
Partial Delete  
[HDD] [RAM]  
(below, For your reference)  
HDD  
1Press [OK] at the start point and end point of the  
section you want to delete.  
2Press [3, 4] to select “Finish” and press [OK].  
Select “Next” and press [OK] to delete other sections.  
3Press [2, 1] to select “Delete” and press [OK].  
008  
PLAY  
Start  
End  
Next  
Finish  
0:43.21  
Start  
End  
- -:- -.- -  
- -:- -.- -  
OK  
RETURN  
You can change an image to be shown as the thumbnail picture in the Title  
View.  
1Press [1] (PLAY) to start play.  
2Press [OK] when the image you want to use as a  
Change Thumbnail  
DIRECT NAVIGATOR Change Thumbnail  
VIDEO  
HDD  
[HDD] [RAM] [-R] [-R]DL] [-RW‹V›]  
[+R] [+R]DL] [+RW]  
008  
Change  
(below, For your reference)  
Finish  
0:00.00  
thumbnail is shown.  
To change the thumbnail  
Restart play and press [3, 4] to select “Change”, then press [OK] at  
the point you want to change.  
Start play and select the image  
Change  
of a thumbnail.  
- -:- -.- -  
ENTER  
3Press [3, 4] to select “Finish” and press [OK].  
You can divide a title into two.  
Divide Title  
DIRECT NAVIGATOR  
HDD  
Divide Title  
VIDEO  
1Press [OK] at the point you want to divide the title.  
2Press [3, 4] to select “Finish” and press [OK].  
3Press [2, 1] to select “Divide” and press [OK].  
[HDD] [RAM]  
008  
PLAY  
Preview  
(below, For your reference)  
Divide  
Finish  
0:43.21  
To confirm the division point  
Divide  
- -:- -.- -  
Press [3, 4] to select “Preview” and press [OK]. (The unit plays 10  
seconds before and after the division point.)  
To change the division point  
Restart play and press [3, 4] to select “Divide”, then press [OK] at the point where you want to divide the  
title.  
[Note]  
The divided titles retain the title name and CPRM property (84) of the original title.  
Video and audio just before and after the dividing point may momentarily cut out.  
§ Multiple editing is possible.  
Chapter operations  
After performing steps 1–7 (44)  
Delete Chapter§  
Press [2, 1] to select “Delete” and press [OK].  
Once deleted, the recorded contents are lost and cannot be restored. Make certain before proceeding.  
Select “Combine Chapters” (below) when you only want to delete the division point between chapters.  
(The recorded contents will not be deleted.)  
[HDD] [RAM]  
Select the point where you want to start a new chapter while viewing the  
title.  
Create Chapter  
DIRECT NAVIGATOR Create Chapter  
VIDEO  
HDD  
[HDD] [RAM]  
008  
PLAY  
1Press [OK] at the point you want to divide.  
Repeat this step to divide at other points.  
Create  
Finish  
(below, For your reference)  
2Press [3, 4] to select “Finish” and press [OK].  
0:43.21  
Press [2, 1] to select “Combine” and press [OK].  
The selected chapter and following chapter are combined.  
Combine Chapters  
[HDD] [RAM]  
§ Multiple editing is possible.  
For your reference  
Use search (35), Time Slip (36) to find the desired point.  
To find the desired point correctly, use Slow-motion (36) and Frame-by-frame (36).  
To skip to the start or end of a title, press [:] (start) or [9] (end).  
RQT8859  
45  
Creating, editing and playing playlists  
DVD  
TV  
3 Press [3, 4] to select “Playlists” and  
Í
Í
VOL  
CH  
press [OK].  
DRIVE  
SELECT  
AV  
DRIVE  
SELECT  
PAGE  
CH  
4 Press [3, 4, 2, 1] to select “Create”  
2 3  
4 5 6  
1
and press [OK].  
ANALOGUE  
CH  
Playlists  
HDD  
- -  
Playlist View  
8 9  
7
- -  
- -  
G-Code  
DELETE  
INPUT  
0
SELECT  
SKIP  
SLOW/SEARCH  
Create  
- -  
- -  
PAUSE  
PLAY/x1.3  
EXIT  
STOP  
5 Press [2, 1] to select the source title  
STATUS  
EXIT  
I
and press [4].  
Press [OK] to select all the chapters in the title, then skip to  
step 7.  
FUNCTION  
MENU  
OK  
3,4,2,1  
OK  
OPTION  
Create  
Playlists  
HDD  
OPTION  
RETURN  
001 ARD 11.10. SAT  
RETURN  
CREATE  
CHAPTER  
Source Title  
001  
Page 001/001  
Page 001/001  
Page 001/001  
DISPLAY  
AUDIO  
MANUAL SKIP  
002  
002  
---  
---  
Source Chapter  
001  
003  
---  
---  
Chapters in Playlist  
---  
You can arrange the chapters (44) to create a playlist.  
---  
---  
Title  
Title  
OK  
OPTION  
Press RETURN to finish.  
RETURN  
Chapter  
Chapter  
Chapter  
Chapter  
Chapter  
6 Press [2, 1] to select the chapter you  
want to add to a playlist and press  
Playlist  
Chapter  
Chapter  
[OK].  
Press [3] to cancel.  
Create  
Playlists  
HDD  
001 ARD 11.10. SAT  
Copying (51) a playlist will create a title.  
Source Title  
001  
Page 001/001  
Page 001/001  
Page 001/001  
002  
002  
---  
---  
Playlists are not recorded separately so this doesn’t use much  
capacity.  
Editing chapters in a playlist does not modify the source titles  
and source chapters.  
You cannot create or edit playlists while recording or copying.  
Source Chapter  
001  
003  
---  
---  
Chapters in Playlist  
---  
---  
---  
OK  
OPTION  
Press RETURN to finish.  
RETURN  
[HDD] [RAM]  
You can also create a new chapter from the source title.  
Press [OPTION] to select “Create Chapter” and press [OK]  
(45, Create Chapter).  
The maximum number of items on a disc:  
–Playlists:  
99  
–Chapters in playlists: Approx. 1000  
(Depends on the state of recording.)  
7 Press [2, 1] to select the position to  
If you exceed the maximum numbers of items for a disc, all the  
items entered will not be recorded.  
insert the chapter and press [OK].  
Playlists  
HDD  
Create  
Creating playlists  
[HDD] [RAM]  
001 ARD 11.10. SAT  
Source Title  
001  
Page 001/001  
Page 001/001  
Page 001/001  
002  
002  
---  
---  
Source Chapter  
001  
Preparation  
003  
---  
---  
---  
Turn on the television and select the appropriate Video input to suit  
the connection to this unit.  
Chapters in Playlist  
---  
---  
Turn the unit on.  
Press [DRIVE SELECT] to select the drive containing the recorded  
title to be edited.  
[RAM] Release protection (60).  
You cannot create or edit a playlist while recording or while  
copying.  
Playlists must be made in accordance with the encoding system  
currently selected in “TV System” (72).  
OK  
Press RETURN to finish.  
RETURN  
Press [3] to select other source titles.  
Repeat steps 6–7 to add other chapters.  
8 Press [RETURN].  
All the selected scenes become the playlist.  
To return to the previous screen  
Press [RETURN].  
1
While stopped  
Press [FUNCTION MENU].  
To exit the screen  
2 Press [3, 4] to select “To Others”  
Press [EXIT].  
and press [OK].  
FUNCTION MENU  
HDD  
Remain 30:00 SP  
Timer Recording  
G-Code Record  
Playback  
Recording  
Advanced Copy  
Playlists  
Delete  
Copy  
Flexible Rec  
DV Auto Rec  
To Others  
OK  
Setup  
RETURN  
HDD Management  
RQT8859  
46  
Editing and playing playlists/chapters  
[HDD] [RAM]  
Playlist operations  
After performing steps 1–5 (left)  
[-RW‹VR›] (Play only)  
Delete§  
Press [2, 1] to select “Delete” and press  
[OK].  
Once deleted, the playlists are lost and  
cannot be restored.  
Make certain before proceeding.  
1
While stopped  
[HDD] [RAM]  
Press [FUNCTION MENU].  
s
t
s
i
l
2 Press [3, 4] to select “To Others”  
y
Playlist information (e.g., total time and date)  
is shown.  
Press [OK] to exit the screen.  
and press [OK].  
Properties  
[HDD] [RAM]  
[-RW‹VR›]  
3 Press [3, 4] to select “Playlists” and  
ingpla  
Properties  
press [OK].  
y
Dinosaur  
No.  
10  
Date 12.10.2006 TUE  
4 Press [3, 4, 2, 1] to select the  
Chapters 002 Total 0:30.53  
ndpla  
playlist.  
RETURN  
OK  
To start play Press [OK].  
To edit Step 5.  
(46, Creating playlists, Step 5–8)  
Create  
tinga  
d
Playlists  
HDD  
01  
Playlist View  
- -  
Playlist View screen  
[HDD] [RAM]  
- -  
Copy§  
Press [2, 1] to select “Copy” and press  
[OK].  
The copied playlist becomes the newest  
one in the playlist view screen.  
12.10. SUN 0:30  
- -  
Create  
- -  
ting,e  
- -  
[HDD] [RAM]  
a
e
To show other pages/Multiple editing (44)  
5 Press [OPTION], then [3, 4] to select  
the operation and press [OK].  
Cr  
You can give names to playlists.  
(59, Entering text)  
Enter  
Name  
[HDD] [RAM]  
If you select “Edit”, press [3, 4] to select the operation and  
press [OK].  
(45, Change Thumbnail)  
Change  
Create  
Thumbnail  
Copy  
Refer to “Playlist  
operations”.  
[HDD] [RAM]  
Enter Name  
Delete  
Change Thumbnail  
Properties  
§ Multiple editing is possible.  
Edit  
Chapter View  
Chapter operations  
[HDD] [RAM]  
After performing steps 1–7 (left)  
Editing chapters in a playlist does not modify the source titles and  
source chapters.  
If you select “Chapter View”  
6 Press [3, 4, 2, 1] to select the  
(46, Creating playlists, Step 5–7)  
Add  
chapter.  
Chapter  
To start play Press [OK].  
To edit Step 7.  
Press [3, 4, 2, 1] to select the position  
to insert the chapter and press [OK].  
Move  
Chapter  
Chapter View screen  
Playlists  
HDD  
Chapter View  
01 ARD 12.10. SUN 0:30  
Playlists  
HDD  
Move Chapter  
001  
002  
---  
---  
---  
---  
---  
---  
0:10.24  
0:19.36  
01 12.10. SUN 0:11  
002  
---  
---  
001  
---  
---  
---  
---  
---  
---  
0:10.24  
0:19.36  
---  
---  
---  
---  
---  
---  
To show other pages/Multiple editing (44)  
7 Press [OPTION], then [3, 4] to select  
the operation and press [OK].  
Add Chapter  
Previous  
Page 01/01  
Next  
OK  
RETURN  
(45, Create Chapter)  
Create  
Chapter  
Move Chapter  
Refer to “Chapter  
operations”.  
Create Chapter  
Combine Chapters  
Delete Chapter  
(45, Combine Chapters)  
Combine  
Chapters  
Playlist View  
(45, Delete Chapter)  
The playlist itself is deleted if you delete all  
the chapters in it.  
You can go back to Playlist View.  
Delete  
Chapter§  
To return to the previous screen  
Press [RETURN].  
§ Multiple editing is possible.  
To exit the screen  
Press [EXIT].  
RQT8859  
47  
Editing still pictures  
1 Press [DIRECT NAVIGATOR].  
2
[HDD] [RAM]  
DVD  
TV  
Í
Í
Press the “Green” button to select  
“PICTURE”.  
VOL  
CH  
DRIVE  
SELECT  
AV  
DRIVE  
SELECT  
PAGE  
CH  
3
Editing an album:  
2 3  
1
Select the album to be edited and press  
4 5 6  
ANALOGUE  
CH  
[OPTION].  
8 9  
7
When you want to create an album using “Create Album”,  
press [OPTION] without selecting album.  
G-Code  
DELETE  
INPUT  
0
SELECT  
SKIP  
SLOW/SEARCH  
:, 9  
Editing a still picture:  
PAUSE  
PLAY/x1.3  
EXIT  
STOP  
;
1 Select the album which contains the still  
picture to edit and press [OK].  
2 Select the still pictures to edit and press  
[OPTION].  
STATUS  
I
DIRECT  
NAVIGATOR  
OK  
3,4,2,1  
To show other pages  
Press [3, 4, 2, 1] to select “Previous” or “Next” and  
press [OK].  
You can also press [:, 9] to show other pages.  
Multiple editing  
OK  
OPTION  
RETURN  
RETURN  
OPTION  
“Green”  
CREATE  
CHAPTER  
DISPLAY  
AUDIO  
REC  
MANUAL SKIP  
REC MODE TIME SLIP PROG/CHECK  
Select with [3, 4, 2, 1] and press [;]. (Repeat.)  
A check mark appears. Press [;] again to cancel.  
To switch to another higher folder (41)  
4 Press [3, 4] to select the operation  
and press [OK].  
To edit the album  
(e.g., [SD])  
[HDD] [RAM] [SD]  
You can edit pictures and albums.  
You can use SD Cards with capacities from 8 MB to 4 GB (7).  
You cannot edit still pictures recorded on CD-R/CD-RW.  
Useful functions during still picture  
play (41)  
Start Slide Show  
Slide Show Setting  
Preparation  
Press [DRIVE SELECT] to select the HDD, DVD or SD drive.  
[RAM] [SD] Release protection (60, Setting the protection).  
Add Pictures  
Create Album  
Edit Album  
Enter Album Name  
Delete Album  
Set up Protection  
Cancel Protection  
Select Folder  
Album and picture operation (49)  
[RAM] [SD]  
This is only displayed when there are other higher  
folders that can be viewed.  
To switch to another higher folder (41)  
To edit still picture  
(e.g., [SD])  
Delete Picture  
Album and picture operation (49)  
Set up Protection  
Cancel Protection  
You can go back to Album View.  
Album View  
To return to the previous screen  
Press [RETURN].  
To exit the screen  
Press [DIRECT NAVIGATOR].  
RQT8859  
48  
Album and picture operation  
After performing steps 1–4, page 48  
Delete Picture§  
Press [2, 1] to select “Delete” and press [OK].  
Delete Album§  
Once deleted, the recorded contents are lost and cannot be restored. Make certain before  
proceeding.  
[HDD] [RAM] [SD]  
s
e
When deleting an album, files other than the still picture files inside the album will also be deleted. (This  
does not apply to folders under the album concerned.)  
ur  
t
You can give names to albums.  
(59, Entering text)  
Album names input using this unit may not be displayed on other equipment.  
Enter Album Name  
lpic  
[HDD] [RAM] [SD]  
i
t
Set up Protection§  
Cancel Protection§  
[HDD] [RAM] [SD]  
If set, this will protect the still picture or album from accidental deletion.  
DIRECT NAVIGATOR  
SD CARD  
Pic  
103__  
ings  
t
i
Press [2, 1] to select “Yes” and press [OK].  
Album Name  
The lock symbol appears when the still picture or album is protected.  
Even if the protection setting is used by this unit to protect an album, the album  
may be deleted by another unit.  
Ed  
0001  
0002  
0006  
0005  
1Press [2, 1] to select “Start” or “Yes” and press [OK].  
Add Pictures  
Create Album  
[HDD] [RAM] [SD]  
2
3
4
e.g.,  
1
Create Album  
HDD  
Step  
Please select album to copy.  
- - -  
007  
008  
12. 5.06 Total 24  
100_DVD  
- - -  
12. 6.06 Total 3  
101_DVD  
- - -  
- - -  
Previous  
Page 02/02  
Next  
OK  
Previous  
Next  
RETURN  
2Press [3, 4, 2, 1] to select the album that contains the still picture you want  
to add and press [OK].  
Create Album  
e.g.,  
Which pictures to copy from the selected album?  
Select pictures to copy  
Copy all pictures  
SELECT  
RETURN  
OK  
[RAM] [SD]  
To switch to another higher folder  
1 Press [OPTION].  
2 Select “Select Folder” and press [OK].  
3 Press [2, 1] to select the higher folder and press [OK].  
3Press [3, 4] to select the item and press [OK].  
If “Select pictures to copy” is selected  
Select the still picture you want to add and press [OK].  
If “Copy all pictures” is selected  
All the still pictures in the album will be copied.  
4Press [2, 1] to select “Yes” or “No” and press [OK].  
If you want to continue copying, select “Yes” and go to step .  
Only for “Create Album”  
5Press [2, 1] to select “Yes” or “No” and press [OK].  
If “Yes” is selected:  
You can give names to albums. (59, Entering text)  
If “No” is selected:  
The recording date of the first picture in the album becomes the album name. (If there is no recording  
date information, the date will appear as [--.--.----].)  
Press [2] to select “Start” and press [OK].  
You cannot copy if multiple albums are selected.  
Copy to DVD-RAM  
[HDD]  
Copy to HDD  
[RAM]  
§ Multiple editing is possible.  
[Note]  
Timer recordings do not start when performing “Add Pictures”, “Create Album”, “Copy to DVD-RAM” or “Copy to HDD”.  
You cannot perform “Add Pictures” or “Create Album” to a higher folder.  
RQT8859  
49  
Delete Navigator  
Using the DELETE Navigator to delete  
1
While stopped  
DVD  
TV  
Í
Í
Press [FUNCTION MENU].  
VOL  
CH  
DRIVE  
SELECT  
AV  
2 Press [3, 4] to select “Delete” and  
DRIVE  
SELECT  
PAGE  
CH  
press [OK].  
2 3  
4 5 6  
1
DELETE Navigator  
HDD  
Title View  
VIDEO  
PICTURE  
- - -  
- - -  
007  
008  
ANALOGUE  
CH  
8 9  
7
ARD 10.10. FRI  
- - -  
ARD 11.10. SAT  
- - -  
G-Code  
DELETE  
INPUT  
DELETE  
¢
0
SELECT  
SKIP  
SLOW/SEARCH  
:, 9  
Previous  
Page 02/02  
Next  
OK  
Select  
OPTION  
Previous  
PAUSE  
PLAY/x1.3  
EXIT  
Next  
STOP  
RETURN  
;
STATUS  
[HDD] [RAM] To switch to the other view  
Press the “Green” button to select “PICTURE”.  
Press the “Red” button to select “VIDEO”.  
EXIT  
I
FUNCTION  
MENU  
OK  
3
If you want to delete a title:  
3,4,2,1  
OPTION  
RETURN  
OK  
RETURN  
“Green”  
Press [3, 4, 2, 1] to select the  
CREATE  
CHAPTER  
DISPLAY  
AUDIO  
REC  
MANUAL SKIP  
“Red”  
title and press [OK].  
REC MODE TIME SLIP PROG/CHECK  
If you want to delete an album:  
Press [3, 4, 2, 1] to select the  
album and press [DELETE ¢].  
[HDD] [RAM] [-R] [-R]DL] [-RW‹V›] [+R] [+R]DL] [+RW] [SD]  
(You cannot delete items on finalised discs.)  
If you want to delete a still picture:  
A title or a picture cannot be restored once it is deleted. Make  
certain before proceeding.  
You cannot delete while recording or copying.  
1 Press [3, 4, 2, 1] to select the album  
that contains the still picture you want to  
delete and press [OK].  
2 Press [3, 4, 2, 1] to select the still  
picture and press [OK].  
Preparation  
Press [DRIVE SELECT] to select the HDD, DVD or SD drive.  
[RAM] [SD] Release protection (60, Setting the protection).  
You can confirm the titles or pictures etc. that you have  
selected using the option menu.  
Available disc space after deleting  
Refer to option menu operations for the “Title View” (44,  
step 5).  
Refer to option menu operations for the “Album View” (48,  
step 4).  
[HDD] [RAM] [SD] If you delete a recorded title (or a still picture),  
the space deleted becomes available for recording.  
Refer to option menu operations for the “Picture (JPEG)  
View” (48, step 4).  
Available disc space increases after  
deleting any of these titles or still  
pictures  
To show other pages  
Press [:, 9] to show other pages.  
Available  
disc space  
......  
Last title  
recorded  
Title  
Title  
Multiple deleting  
Select with [3, 4, 2, 1] and press [;]. (Repeat.)  
A check mark appears. Press [;] again to cancel.  
[-RW‹V›] [+RW] Available recording space increases only when the  
last recorded title is deleted.  
4 Press [2] to select “Delete” and press  
[OK].  
Available disc space does  
Available disc space  
not increase even after  
increases after deleting  
The title, album or the picture is deleted.  
deleting  
To return to the previous screen  
Press [RETURN].  
Last title  
recorded  
Available  
disc space  
......  
Title  
Title  
To exit the screen  
Press [EXIT].  
Deleting titles or pictures during play  
[-R] [-R]DL] [+R] [+R]DL] Available space does not increase even  
after the contents are deleted.  
1
While playing  
Press [DELETE ¢].  
You cannot delete a picture during a Slide Show.  
2 Press [2, 1] to select “Delete” and  
press [OK].  
The title or the picture is deleted.  
RQT8859  
50  
Copying titles or playlists  
Copy  
Advanced Copy  
Easy copying from HDD to DVD with no difficult Make a copy list and then copy.  
Features  
You can set the unit to copy titles or playlists in the  
settings.  
way you want.  
HDD DVD  
Copy direction  
DVD HDD  
[RAM] [-RW‹VR›] [+RW]  
[DVD-V] (Only from a finalised disc)  
s
t
s
i
l
[DVD-V] You cannot perform high-speed copy with  
finalised discs.  
[+RW] You cannot perform high-speed copy from  
+RW to HDD.  
y
High speed mode copy§1  
pla  
or  
§2  
Changing recording mode  
Finalise§3  
s
[-R] [-R]DL] [-RW‹V›] [+R] [+R]DL]  
[-R] [-R]DL] [-RW‹V›] [+R] [+R]DL]  
Automatically finalised  
Can be selected  
High speed mode  
Normal speed mode  
High speed mode  
Normal speed mode  
ngitle  
Copying SD Video from an SD Card  
y
(55)  
[HDD] [RAM] only  
Copying playlists§4  
Cop  
/
§5  
§5  
Are chapters maintained?  
Are thumbnails maintained?  
Recording and Playing while Copying  
tor  
§6  
§7  
§6  
ga  
§8  
i
v
§1 To high speed copy titles (or playlists created from those titles), set “Rec for High Speed Copy” to “On” before recording to the HDD  
(The default setting is “On”. 65).  
However in the following cases, copying to DVD-R, DVD-R DL, DVD-RW (DVD-Video format), +R, +R DL and +RW using the high speed mode does not work.  
When arranging multiple titles for copying, if any titles are recorded with “Rec for High Speed Copy” to “Off”, then you cannot perform with  
high-speed copy.  
Playlists created from titles using a variety of recording modes or multiple titles using FR recording mode.  
Playlists mixed with a variety of audio types (Dolby Digital and LPCM, etc.).  
Titles that contain many deleted segments.  
SD Video titles copied to the HDD from an SD Card.  
Na  
te  
le  
De  
[+R] [+R]DL] [+RW] Titles recorded in “EP” mode and “FR (recordings 5 hours or longer)” mode. (Displayed  
)
§2 If you select a recording mode with better picture quality than the original, the picture quality does not improve. (However it does prevent  
against degradation of picture quality.)  
[+R]DL] You cannot copy in “EP” or “FR (recordings 5 hours or longer)” mode.  
§3 You cannot select “Top Menu” or “Auto-Play Select”.  
If you want to set auto-play select or the background colour, select “Top Menu” or “Auto-Play Select” in “DVD Management” before copying (  
§4 You cannot copy playlists with a play time more than 8 hours.  
62).  
When you copy a playlist, it will become a title in the destination drive.  
§5 [RAM] [-R]DL] [+R]DL] [+RW] : One title becomes one chapter.  
[-R] [-RW‹V›] [+R] : Chapters are created automatically ([-R] [-RW‹V›] about 5-minutes [+R] about 8-minutes) when finalising after copying the disc.  
§6 Thumbnails return to the default position.  
§7 When copying playlists, the thumbnails may not reflect changes made to them.  
§8 Possible only with titles on the HDD  
(However it is not possible when copying with automatic finalisation or when copying SD Video from an SD Card.)  
You cannot perform chasing play or edit, etc. while copying.  
You cannot play a playlist while copying titles with “One time only recording” restriction (8).  
–Still pictures cannot be played.  
Approximate copying times (Max. speed)  
(excludes time required to write data management information)  
5X Speed  
DVD-RAM  
12X Speed  
DVD-R§1  
4X Speed  
4X Speed  
8X Speed  
+R§4  
4X Speed  
+R DL§2  
4X Speed  
+RW  
HDD  
DVD-R DL§2  
DVD-RW§3  
Recording  
Required  
Required  
Required  
Required  
Required  
Required  
Required  
Recorded  
Speed  
Speed  
Speed  
Speed  
Speed  
Speed  
Speed  
Mode  
XP  
time  
12 min.  
6 min.  
3 min.  
2 min.  
time  
time  
time  
time  
time  
time  
5
x
5 min. 46 s. 10  
2 min. 30 s. 24  
1 min. 21 s. 44  
58 sec. 62  
48 sec. 75  
x
x
x
x
x
15 min.  
7 min. 30 s.  
4
8
x
x
15 min.  
7 min. 30 s.  
4
8
x
x
8 min. 20 s.  
7
x
15 min.  
7 min. 30 s.  
4
8
x
x
15 min.  
7 min. 30 s.  
4
8
x
x
1
SP  
LP  
EP (6H)  
EP (8H)  
10  
20  
30  
x
x
x
x
3 min. 45 s. 16  
1 min. 53 s. 32  
x
x
1 hour  
3 min. 45 s. 16  
2 min. 30 s. 24  
1 min. 53 s. 32  
x
x
x
3 min. 45 s. 16  
2 min. 30 s. 24  
1 min. 57 s. 31  
x
x
x
3 min. 45 s. 16  
x
3 min. 45 s. 16x  
1 min. 30 s. 40  
The above values indicate the quickest possible times and speeds to high speed copy a one hour title recorded on the HDD to a high speed  
recording compatible disc. Depending on what part of the disc is being written to, the features of the disc, etc., the times and speeds will vary.  
§1 In this unit, copying with a 16X Speed DVD-R disc will be performed at the same speed as with a 12X Speed DVD-R disc.  
§2 In this unit, copying with 8X Speed discs, DVD-R DL and +R DL, will be performed at the same speed as with 4X Speed discs, DVD-R DL and +R DL.  
§3 In this unit, copying with a 6X Speed DVD-RW disc will be performed at the same speed as with a 4X Speed DVD-RW disc.  
§4 In this unit, copying with a 16X Speed +R disc will be performed at the same speed as with a 8X Speed +R disc.  
[Note]  
When recording or playing while copying, the unit may not use the maximum recording speed.  
Depending on the condition of the disc, the unit may not copy using the maximum speed.  
Regarding copying to DVD-R DL (Dual Layer, single-sided) and  
+R DL (Double Layer, single-sided)  
Regarding copying of the broadcasts that allow “One time  
only recording”  
When not copying in high speed mode, titles are temporarily copied at  
normal speed to the HDD and then copied at high speed to DVD-R DL and  
+R DL. The titles that were temporarily copied to the HDD are then deleted.  
You cannot copy to DVD-R DL and +R DL in the following cases.  
–When there is not enough free space on the HDD. (When  
copying to a new blank disc, if you intend to fill a new disc when  
copying to it, the equivalent of up to 4 hours of free space in SP  
mode is needed on the HDD.)  
You can copy a recorded title to a CPRM (84) compatible DVD-  
RAM, however, the title is deleted from the HDD.  
Titles or playlists cannot be copied from DVD-RAM to the HDD.  
Titles will not be copied if they are protected (45).  
You cannot copy playlists created from “One time only recording”  
titles.  
Titles with recording limitations and playlists cannot be registered  
on the same copying list.  
–When the number of titles recorded to the HDD and the number of titles  
to be copied to the DVD-R DL and +R DL is greater than 500 in total.  
When playing a title recorded on both layers, video and audio may  
momentarily cut out when the unit is switching layers. (5)  
RQT8859  
51  
Copying titles or playlists  
1
While stopped  
Press [FUNCTION MENU].  
DVD  
TV  
2 Press [3, 4] to select “Copy” and  
Í
Í
VOL  
CH  
press [OK].  
DRIVE  
SELECT  
AV  
COPY Navigator  
HDD  
Destination Capacity: 4310MB  
Size: 0MB( 0%)  
Total  
:
0
PAGE  
CH  
No. Name Date Day Time Name of title  
001  
2 3  
ARD 26. 9. FRI 13:30  
1
002  
003  
004  
ZDF 27. 9. SAT 12:15  
AV2 3. 10. FRI 20:00  
ARD 3. 10. FRI 22:05  
Numbered  
buttons  
4 5 6  
Rec time  
0:52(SP)  
005 AV2 4. 10. SAT 16:10  
006 ZDF 10.10. FRI 9:25  
007 ARD 10.10. FRI 13:30  
008 ARD 11.10. SAT 21:00  
---  
ANALOGUE  
CH  
8 9  
7
G-Code  
DELETE  
Page 01/01  
INPUT  
0
SELECT  
OK  
Select  
OPTION  
RETURN  
SKIP  
SLOW/SEARCH  
:, 9  
;
1
3 Press [3, 4] to select the title you  
PAUSE  
PLAY/x1.3  
EXIT  
STOP  
want to copy and press [OK].  
STATUS  
STATUS  
I
To show other pages  
Press [:, 9] to show other pages.  
FUNCTION  
MENU  
OK  
3,4,2,1  
Multiple editing  
Select with [3, 4] and press [;]. (Repeat.)  
Press [OK] to register.  
OK  
OPTION  
RETURN  
RETURN  
“Green”  
OPTION  
“Red”  
CREATE  
CHAPTER  
DISPLAY  
AUDIO  
REC  
MANUAL SKIP  
A check mark appears. Press [;] again to cancel.  
REC MODE TIME SLIP PROG/CHECK  
4
After you start copying DVD-R, DVD-R DL, DVD-RW (DVD-  
Video format), +R and +R DL discs, they become play-  
only and you can no longer record or edit.  
Before copying  
When copying a title with main and secondary audio  
Select the audio type for recording bilingual broadcast from  
“Bilingual Audio Selection” (66) when:  
–Copying to a DVD-R, DVD-R DL, DVD-RW (DVD-Video format),  
+R, +R DL and +RW.  
Press [2, 1] to select “Start” and  
press [OK].  
Copy starts.  
–When “Audio Mode for XP Recording” is set to “LPCM” (66)  
and you are copying in XP mode.  
To return to the previous screen  
Press [RETURN].  
Speed and recording mode when copying  
To stop copying (54)  
[HDD] ,-. [RAM] : High speed  
[HDD]  
>
[-R] [-R]DL] [-RW‹V›] [+R] [+R]DL] [+RW] : Refer to the following table.  
COPY Navigator/Copying list icons and  
Rec for High Speed Copy (65)  
Copy speed  
functions (54)  
Only titles recorded with “Rec for High  
Speed Copy” set to “On”. §  
High speed  
To check the properties of a title and sort COPY  
Only titles recorded with “Rec for High  
Speed Copy” set to “Off”.  
Navigator  
1 Press [3, 4] to select the title and press  
Normal speed  
When making a copy of multiple titles that  
were recorded with “Rec for High Speed  
Copy” set to “On” and “Off”.  
[OPTION].  
COPY Navigator  
HDD  
Destination Capacity: 4310MB  
Size: 0MB( 0%)  
No. Name Date Day Time Name of title  
Total  
:
0
§ In the following cases, even if “Rec for High Speed Copy” is set to  
“On”, copy will perform at normal speed.  
[+R] [+R]DL] [+RW] When the copying source was recorded in “EP”  
001  
002  
003  
004  
ARD 26. 9. FRI 13:30  
ZDF 27. 9. SAT 12:15  
AV2 3. 10. FRI 20:00  
ARD 3. 10. FRI 22:05  
Rec time  
0:52(SP)  
005 AV2 4. 10. SAT 16:10  
006 ZDF 10.10. FRI 9:25  
007 ARD 10.10. FRI 13:30  
008 ARD 11.10. SAT 21:00  
---  
or “FR (recordings 5 hours or longer)” mode.  
Page 01/01  
Properties  
Sort  
When the copy destination (disc) does not have enough space.  
When the title aspect for the copying source and “Aspect for  
Recording” do not match.  
When the title aspect for the copying source is 16:9:  
[+R] [+R]DL] [+RW]  
OK  
RETURN  
2 Press [3, 4] to select “Properties” or “Sort”  
and press [OK].  
Properties:  
[-R] [-R]DL] [-RW‹V›] copying source was recorded in “EP” or “FR  
(recordings 5 hours or longer)” mode.  
The name, recording date, channel etc. of the selected title are  
shown.  
[Note]  
Sort:  
Titles and playlists recorded using a different encoding system (PAL  
or NTSC) from the TV system currently selected on the unit cannot  
be copied.  
Press [3, 4] to select the item and press [OK].  
This changes the way that titles are displayed. You can select to  
display titles by No., recording date, day, channel, recording start  
time and title name. (You cannot select a title if it has a check mark.)  
If you close the COPY Navigator screen, the display order is  
cancelled.  
Preparation  
Insert a disc that you can use for copying (4, 5).  
Confirm that there is enough remaining disc space.  
Copy  
[Note]  
When copying titles in high speed mode to high speed recording  
compatible DVD-RAM 5X, DVD-R 8X, +R 8X or +RW 4X, the  
sound of the disc rotating becomes louder than normal.  
If you want copy to perform more quietly, select “Normal (Silent)” in  
“DVD Speed for High Speed Copy” in the Setup menu (65).  
If you register multiple titles, they are copied in order from the title  
at the top of the screen and not in the order you registered them.  
To change the order that titles are copied, create a copying list and  
then copy the contents of the list (53).  
DVD-R, DVD-R DL, DVD-RW (DVD-Video format), +R and +R DL  
are automatically finalised (84). After finalising, the discs  
become play-only and you can also play them on other DVD  
equipment. However, you can no longer record or edit.  
[HDD] > [RAM] [-R] [-R]DL] [-RW‹V›] [+R] [+R]DL] [+RW]  
(You cannot copy to finalised discs.)  
When copying in normal speed, recording mode will be set to FR.  
(However, if there is still not enough space after setting to FR mode,  
copy will not be performed.)  
RQT8859  
52  
6 Register titles and playlists for copy.  
Copying using the copying list–  
Advanced Copy  
[HDD] ,-. [RAM] [+RW]  
[-RW‹VR›] > [HDD]  
If you are going to copy a registered list without making any  
changes to it (step 7).  
1 Press [3, 4] to select “Create List” and press [1].  
Copy  
[HDD] > [-R] [-R]DL] [-RW‹V›] [+R] [+R]DL]  
[SD] > [HDD] [RAM]  
Cancel All  
Destination Capacity: 4343MB  
( 0%)  
0MB  
Size:  
Name of item  
New item (Total=0)  
1
2
3
Copy Direction  
HDD ꢀꢁDVD  
No. Size  
s
t
You can order titles and playlists as desired for copy to disc.  
Copy Mode  
VIDEO High Speed  
s
i
l
Create List  
y
See also “Before copying” (52).  
Page 01/01  
Create copy list.  
Start Copying  
pla  
OK  
OPTION  
RETURN  
1
While stopped  
or  
s
2 Press [3, 4] to select “New item” and press [OK].  
3 Press the “Red” button to select “VIDEO” or press the  
“Green” button to select “Playlists”.  
Press [FUNCTION MENU].  
2 Press [3, 4] to select “To Others”  
Create List  
HDD  
ngitle  
VIDEO Playlists  
y
and press [OK].  
- - -  
007  
008  
0:30(XP)  
ARD 10.10. FRI  
- - -  
ARD 11.10. SAT  
- - -  
Cop  
3 Press [3, 4] to select “Advanced  
- - -  
Copy” and press [OK].  
Previous  
Page 02/02  
Next  
Previous  
Copy  
OK  
Select  
OPTION  
Next  
RETURN  
Cancel All  
Source  
HDD  
DVD  
1 Copy Direction  
HDD ꢀꢁDVD  
4 Press [3, 4, 2, 1] to select the titles or playlists and  
press [OK].  
Destination  
Copy Mode  
2
VIDEO High Speed  
When copying to a disc using high speed mode,  
0
Create List  
3
[-R] [-R]DL] [-RW‹V›] : only items indicated with “  
” can be registered.  
” or  
Select the copy direction.  
Start Copying  
OK  
RETURN  
If you are not going to change the registered list press [4]  
several times (step 7).  
[+R] [+R]DL] [+RW] : only items indicated with “  
be registered.  
” can  
To select a multiple number of items together, press  
[;] to add the check mark and press [OK]  
(below, Multiple editing).  
To show other pages (below)  
To edit the copying list (54)  
4 Set the copy direction.  
If you are not going to change the copying direction, press  
[4] (step 5).  
1 Press [3, 4] to select “Copy Direction” and press [1].  
2 Press [3, 4] to select “Source” and press [OK].  
3 Press [3, 4] to select the drive and press [OK].  
4 Press [3, 4] to select “Destination” and press [OK].  
5 Press [3, 4] to select the drive and press [OK].  
The same drive as the copy source cannot be selected.  
6 Press [2] to confirm.  
You can register a multiple number of titles and  
playlists on the copying list by repeating  
steps 24.  
You cannot start copying when the value of the “Size”  
(54) exceeds 100% (“Destination Capacity” is not  
sufficient).  
5 Press [2] to confirm.  
5 Set the recording mode.  
If you are not going to change the recording mode, press [4]  
(step 6).  
7 Press [3, 4] to select “Start  
Copying” and press [OK].  
1 Press [3, 4] to select “Copy Mode” and press [1].  
When copying titles in high speed mode to high speed  
recording compatible DVD-RAM 5X, DVD-R 8X, +R 8X or  
+RW 4X, the sound of the disc rotating becomes louder than  
normal.  
2
Press [3, 4] to select “Format” and press [OK]  
.
3 Press [3, 4] to select “VIDEO” and press [OK].  
4
5
Press [3, 4] to select “Recording Mode” and press  
[OK]  
Press [3, 4] to select the mode and press [OK]  
.
If you want copy to perform more quietly, select “Normal  
(Silent)” in “DVD Speed for High Speed Copy” in the Setup  
menu (65).  
.
6 Press [2] to confirm.  
8 Press [2, 1] to select “Yes” and  
press [OK] to start copying.  
[HDD] > [-R] [-R]DL] [-RW‹V›] [+R] [+R]DL]  
Press [2, 1] to select “Copy & Finalise” or  
“Copy Only” and press [OK].  
If “Copy & Finalise” is selected  
After finalising, the discs become play-only and you can also  
play them on other DVD equipment. However, you can no  
longer record or edit.  
To show other pages  
Press [3, 4, 2, 1] to select “Previous” or “Next” and press  
[OK].  
You can also press [:, 9] to show other pages.  
Multiple editing  
Select with [3, 4, 2, 1] and press [;]. (Repeat.)  
Press [OK] to register to the list.  
A check mark appears. Press [;] again to cancel.  
When you switch between the “VIDEO” and “Playlists” tab, the  
check mark is cancelled.  
RQT8859  
(continued on the next page)  
53  
Copying titles or playlists  
(Continued)  
To play DVD-R, DVD-R DL,DVD-RW (DVD-Video format), +R and  
+R DL on other players, it is necessary to finalise them after  
copy.  
Refer to the control reference on page 52.  
To stop copying  
To edit the copying list  
Delete All  
Press and hold [RETURN] for 3 seconds.  
(You cannot stop while finalising)  
Select the item in step 6–4 (53, right column)  
Add  
1
2
Press [OPTION].  
Press [3, 4] to select the operation and press  
When High-speed copying  
All titles that have completely copied at the point cancelled are  
copied.  
Delete  
Move  
[OK].  
Delete All:  
When Normal Speed copying  
Copies until the point cancelled. However titles with “One time only  
recording” restriction, only titles that have completely copied at the  
point cancelled are copied to the disc. Titles that are cancelled  
before the copy is complete are not copied and remain on the HDD.  
[-R]DL] [+R]DL] If copy is cancelled during the step while  
temporarily copying to the HDD, then nothing will be copied.  
However, if copy is cancelled during the step while copying to  
disc from the HDD, then only titles completely copied at the  
point canceled are copied.  
Delete all items registered on the copying list.  
Press [2, 1] to select “Yes” and press [OK].  
Add:  
Add new items to the copying list.  
Press [3, 4, 2, 1] to select the playlists and titles to be added and  
press [OK].  
Delete:  
Delete the selected items.  
Press [2, 1] to select “Yes” and press [OK].  
You can also delete multiple items (53, Multiple editing).  
Move:  
Move selected items or change the order of items on the copying list.  
Press [3, 4] to select the destination and press [OK].  
Even if the title was not copied to the DVD-R, DVD-R DL, DVD-  
RW (DVD-Video format), +R, +R DL or +RW, the amount of  
remaining writable disc space becomes less.  
To return to the previous screen  
Press [RETURN].  
To cancel all registered copying setting and lists  
After performing steps 1–3 (53, left column)  
Recording and playing while copying  
You can record and play using the HDD while high speed  
copying. (Only when high speed copying without finalising)  
Still pictures cannot be played.  
1
2
Press [3, 4] to select “Cancel All” and press [OK].  
Press [2, 1] to select “Yes” and press [OK].  
The settings and lists may be cancelled in the following situations.  
–When a title, still picture, etc. has been recorded or deleted at the  
copy source  
–When steps have been taken, for instance, to turn off the unit,  
open the tray, change the copy direction, etc.  
Press [OK] to cancel the screen display.  
To confirm the current progress  
Press [STATUS ].  
[Note]  
Timer recordings executed while copying are recorded to the  
HDD regardless of the recording drive settings.  
(Only when high speed copying without finalising)  
COPY Navigator/Copying list icons and functions  
COPY Navigator/Copying list indicators  
Titles and playlists that can be copied in high  
speed mode to DVD-R, DVD-R DL,  
DVD-RW (DVD-Video format), +R, +R DL, +RW  
Titles and playlists that can be copied in high  
speed mode to DVD-R, DVD-R DL,  
DVD-RW (DVD-Video format)  
(However, titles and playlists cannot be copied in  
high speed mode to +R, +R DL, +RW)  
[+R]DL]  
is displayed, but copy cannot be  
performed.  
Title with “One time only recording” restriction  
(8, When recording the “One time only  
recording” broadcasts)  
Titles deleted from the HDD by “One time only  
recording” restriction after copying.  
(8, When recording the “One time only  
recording” broadcasts)  
Title or playlist contains still picture(s)  
Still picture(s) cannot be copied.  
Title or playlist recorded using a different encoding  
system from that of the TV system currently  
selected on the unit.  
(NTSC)  
(PAL)  
Titles and playlists displaying these marks  
cannot be selected.  
Data size of each registered item  
Destination Capacity: 4343MB  
Size:  
Size:  
0MB (0%)  
No. Size  
Name of item  
Data size recorded to the copy  
destination  
New item (Total=0)  
When copying at normal speed, the  
total data size will change according to  
the recording mode.  
Page 01/01  
Create copy list.  
The total data size shown may be  
larger than the sum of the data sizes  
for each registered item, because of  
data management information being  
written to the copy destination, etc.  
RQT8859  
54  
8
When the top menu is displayed  
Copying a finalised DVD-R, DVD-R DL,  
DVD-RW (DVD-Video format), +R and  
Press [3, 4, 2, 1] to select the title  
you want to start copying, and press  
[OK].  
+R DL  
[DVD-V] > [HDD]  
You can copy the content of finalised DVD-R, DVD-R DL, DVD-RW  
(DVD-Video format), +R, and +R DL to the HDD and re-edit.  
While playing a disc, the content being played is copied to the HDD  
according to the set time.  
My favorite  
01/02  
s
t
01  
Chapter  
02  
Chapter  
1
2
s
i
l
03  
Chapter  
04  
Chapter  
3
4
y
05  
06  
If you perform search, frame-by-frame or pause while copying, that  
portion of title is not recorded.  
When “Rec for High Speed Copy” (65) is set to “On” and you  
make a copy, the copy will be made using the picture size selected  
in “Aspect for Recording” (65) of the Setup menu.  
pla  
While playing in order, all the titles after the selected title are  
recorded until the set time. (After the last title on the disc has  
finished playing the top menu is recorded until the set time is  
reached.)  
or  
s
To return to the previous screen  
ngitle  
Operations and on screen displays during copy are also  
recorded.  
Almost all DVD-Video on sale have been treated to prevent  
illegal copying, and cannot be copied.  
Press [RETURN].  
y
To stop copying  
Press [].  
You can also press and hold [RETURN] for 3 seconds to stop  
copying.  
If stopped partway, copying will be up to that point.  
Cop  
The following cannot be copied: Video CD, Audio CD and so on.  
Preparation  
Insert the finalised disc (34).  
[Note]  
The screen saver on the right is recorded at the  
beginning.  
After performing steps 1–5 (“Format” is automatically set to “DVD-  
Video”) (53, Copying using the copying list–Advanced Copy)  
The content is recorded as 1 title from the start of  
copy to the end.  
If play does not begin automatically or if the top  
menu does not display automatically, press [1] (PLAY) to start.  
Even if you copy a high quality video/audio DVD, the original  
picture and audio quality cannot be exactly replicated.  
If you want to copy a title from a finalised DVD-RW (DVD Video  
Recording format), create a copy list and then copy (53, Copying  
using the copying list–Advanced Copy).  
6 Set “Copy Time”.  
If you are not going to change the setting (step 7).  
Setting the unit to copy according to the set  
time  
1 Press [3, 4] to select “Copy Time” and press [1].  
2 Press [3, 4] to select “Time Setting” and press [OK].  
Setting the unit to copy all the content on the disc  
3 Press [3, 4] to select “Off” and press [OK].  
4 Press [2] to confirm.  
Copying SD Video from an SD Card  
Motion pictures encoded in the MPEG2 format, which have been  
taken by a Panasonic SD Video Camera, digital video camera etc,  
can be stored on HDD or DVD-RAM.  
(All the recordings on the same date become a title.)  
You cannot playback SD Video on an SD Card with this unit.  
You must copy the files to the HDD or a DVD-RAM.  
You cannot playback or record while copying SD Video.  
This unit cannot copy AVCHD format motion pictures from an SD  
Card.  
Copy will continue until there is not enough available  
recording space on the HDD.  
Setting the copying time  
3 Press [3, 4] to select “On” and press [OK].  
4 Press [3, 4] to select “Copy Time” and press [OK].  
Copy  
Cancel All  
SD Video  
1 Copy Direction  
DVD ꢀꢁHDD  
VIDEO§  
2
Hour  
00 Min.  
Copy Mode  
2
3
DVD-Video XP  
Set the time a few minutes  
longer.  
Copy Time  
HDD  
Press OK to change the setting.  
Start Copying  
OK  
DVD-RAM  
RETURN  
§ Conventionally recorded programmes  
5 Press [2, 1] to select “Hour” and “Min.” and press [3, 4]  
to set the recording time.  
6 Press [OK].  
7 Press [2] to confirm.  
Copying to the HDD continues for the set time even after  
the content being played finishes.  
The display below automatically appears when you insert a card  
into the SD Card slot while stopped.  
Press [3, 4] to select “Copy Video (MPEG2)” and press [OK].  
Then go to step 7 on page 53.  
SD Card  
Set a few minutes longer than the source title, in order to  
include the operation time before play begins.  
You can also set the recording time with the numbered  
buttons.  
Album View  
Copy Pictures (JPEG)  
Copy Video (MPEG2)  
SELECT  
RETURN  
OK  
7 Press [3, 4] to select “Start  
How to copy  
Copying” and press [OK].  
Refer to “Copying using the copying list–Advanced Copy” (53)  
Please set the items in step 4 and 5 as shown below.  
Press [2, 1] to select “Yes” and press [OK] to start copying.  
The disc top menu is displayed.  
Disc play automatically begins from title 1 when “Title 1” is  
selected from the “Auto-Play Select” menu when finalising  
the disc (62).  
Copy Direction:  
Source : SD CARD  
Copy Mode:  
Format : VIDEO  
SD Video on an SD Card are automatically registered on the  
copy list.  
If there are no SD Video on an SD Card, “Copy Video  
(MPEG2)” is not displayed.  
RQT8859  
55  
Copying still pictures  
6 Register still pictures for copy.  
If you are going to copy a registered list without making any  
DVD  
TV  
changes to it (step 7).  
Í
Í
VOL  
CH  
DRIVE  
You can register still pictures or still picture folders.  
SELECT  
AV  
DRIVE  
SELECT  
Still pictures and folders cannot be registered on the same  
list.  
PAGE  
CH  
2 3  
4 5 6  
1
Numbered  
buttons  
Copy  
Destination Capacity: 4343MB  
Cancel All  
Picture  
Picture/Folder  
ANALOGUE  
CH  
1 Copy Direction  
No. Size  
Name of item  
New item (Total=0)  
8 9  
7
SD CARD ꢀꢁHDD  
G-Code  
DELETE  
INPUT  
Copy Mode  
PICTURE High Speed  
2
0
SELECT  
SKIP  
SLOW/SEARCH  
Create List  
3
:, 9  
Page 01/01  
Create copy list.  
Start Copying  
OK  
PAUSE  
PLAY/x1.3  
EXIT  
STOP  
;
OPTION  
RETURN  
STATUS  
To register individual still pictures  
1 Press [3, 4] to select “Create List” and press [1].  
2 Press [3, 4] to select “New item” and press [OK].  
3 Press [3, 4, 2, 1] to select the still picture and press  
[OK].  
I
FUNCTION  
MENU  
OK  
3,4,2,1  
OK  
OPTION  
OPTION  
RETURN  
To select a multiple number of items together, press  
[;] to add the check mark and press [OK] (57,  
Multiple editing).  
To show other pages (57)  
To select the still pictures in another folder (57)  
To edit the copying list (57)  
RETURN  
CREATE  
[HDD] [RAM] [SD]  
You can use SD Cards with capacities from 8 MB to 4 GB (7).  
SDHC Memory Cards used for recording with this unit can only be  
used with other SDHC Memory Card-compatible equipment.  
SDHC Memory Cards cannot be used with equipment that is only  
compatible with SD Memory Cards.  
You can register a multiple number of still pictures on  
the copying list by repeating steps 23.  
You cannot copy pictures recorded to CD-R/CD-RW.  
[SD]  
4 Press [2] to confirm.  
While stopped put the card in the slot, and the menu (below) is  
automatically displayed.  
Press [3, 4] to select “Copy Pictures (JPEG)”, press [OK] and then  
go to step 4 on page 57, “Copying all the still pictures on a card—  
Copy All Pictures”.  
To register on a folder by folder basis  
1 Press [3, 4] to select “Create List” and press [1].  
2
Press [3, 4] to select “Picture/Folder” and press [OK].  
SD Card  
Copy  
Album View  
Destination Capacity: 4343MB  
Copy Pictures (JPEG)  
Copy Video (MPEG2)  
Cancel All  
Picture  
Picture/Folder  
1 Copy Direction  
No. Size  
Name of item  
SD CARD > HDD  
New item (Total=0)  
Copy Mode  
2
SELECT  
RETURN  
OK  
3 Press [3, 4] to select “Folder” and press [OK].  
4 Press [3, 4] to select “New item” and press [OK].  
5 Press [3, 4] to select the folder and press [OK].  
Press [RETURN] to exit the screen.  
Copying using the copying list  
To select a multiple number of items together, press  
[;] to add the check mark and press [OK] (57,  
Multiple editing).  
To show other pages (57)  
To switch to another higher folder (57)  
To edit the copying list (57)  
1
While stopped  
Press [FUNCTION MENU].  
2 Press [3, 4] to select “To Others”  
and press [OK].  
You can register a multiple number of folders on the  
copying list by repeating steps 45.  
3 Press [3, 4] to select “Advanced  
Copy” and press [OK].  
6 Press [2] to confirm.  
Copy  
7 Press [3, 4] to select “Start  
Cancel All  
Source  
SD CARD  
HDD  
1 Copy Direction  
SD CARD > HDD  
Copying” and press [OK].  
For individual still pictures only  
Destination  
Copy Mode  
PICTURE High Speed  
2
0
Create List  
3
When specifying another folder as the copying destination,  
select “Folder”.  
If you are not going to change the registered list press [4]  
several times (step 7).  
Folder  
New folder  
001 100__DVD  
002 101__DVD  
003 102__DVD  
4 Set the copy direction.  
---  
New folder  
---  
If you are not going to change the copying direction, press  
[4] (step 5).  
1 Press [3, 4] to select “Copy Direction” and press  
[1].  
8 Press [2, 1] to select “Yes” and  
press [OK] to start copying.  
2 Press [3, 4] to select “Source” and press [OK].  
3 Press [3, 4] to select the drive and press [OK].  
4
Press [3, 4] to select “Destination” and press [OK].  
To stop copying  
Press and hold [RETURN] for 3 seconds.  
5 Press [3, 4] to select the drive and press [OK].  
The same drive as the copy source can be selected.  
6 Press [2] to confirm.  
To return to the previous screen  
5 Set the recording mode.  
Press [RETURN].  
If you are not going to change the recording mode, press [4]  
(step 6).  
1 Press [3, 4] to select “Copy Mode” and press [1].  
2
3
Press [3, 4] to select “Format” and press [OK].  
RQT8859  
Press [3, 4] to select “PICTURE” and press [OK]  
“Recording Mode” is automatically set to “High Speed”.  
4 Press [2] to confirm.  
.
56  
To show other pages  
Press [3, 4, 2, 1] to select “Previous” or “Next” and press  
[OK].  
Copying all the still pictures on a card—  
Copy All Pictures  
You can also press [:, 9] to show other pages.  
[SD] > [HDD] or [RAM]  
Multiple editing  
Select with [3, 4, 2, 1] and press [;]. (Repeat.)  
Press [OK] to register to the list.  
Preparation  
Press [DRIVE SELECT] to select the SD drive.  
s
e
A check mark appears. Press [;] again to cancel.  
1
While stopped  
ur  
t
To edit the copying list  
Press [FUNCTION MENU].  
Select the item in step 6–3 (for a still picture) or 6–5  
Delete All  
lpic  
i
t
(for a folder) (56, right column)  
2 Press [3, 4] to select “To Others”  
Add  
1
2
Press [OPTION].  
Press [3, 4] to select the operation and press  
and press [OK].  
Delete  
ings  
[OK].  
y
3 Press [3, 4] to select “Copy All  
Pictures” and press [OK].  
Copy All Pictures  
Delete All:  
Cop  
Delete all items registered on the copying list.  
Press [2, 1] to select “Yes” and press [OK].  
Add:  
Copy from  
SD CARD  
Add new items to the copying list.  
Press [3, 4, 2, 1] to select the still picture or folder to be added  
and press [OK].  
Copy to  
HDD  
Delete:  
Delete the selected items.  
Press [2, 1] to select “Yes” and press [OK].  
You can also delete multiple items (above, Multiple editing).  
4 Press [3, 4] to select “Copy to” and  
press [2, 1] to select the drive.  
5 Press [3, 4, 2, 1] to select “Copy”  
and press [OK].  
To cancel all registered copying settings and lists  
After performing steps 1–3 (56)  
To stop copying  
Press and hold [RETURN] for 3 seconds.  
1
2
Press [3, 4] to select “Cancel All” and press [OK].  
Press [2, 1] to select “Yes” and press [OK].  
The settings and lists may be cancelled in the following situations.  
–When a title or still picture has been recorded or deleted at the  
copy source  
To return to the previous screen  
Press [RETURN].  
–When steps have been taken, for instance, to turn off the unit,  
remove the card, open the tray, change the copy direction, etc.  
To select another folder  
(7, Structure of folders displayed by this unit)  
1 Press [3, 4, 2, 1] to select “Folder” and press [OK].  
If you want to switch to another higher folder (below).  
2 Press [3, 4] to select the folder and press [OK].  
Create List  
SD CARD  
Create List  
SD CARD  
Picture (JPEG)  
Folder  
Folder  
103__DVD  
\DCIM\100__DVD  
0001  
----  
----  
0002  
----  
----  
0003  
----  
0004  
----  
001 100__DVD  
002 101__DVD  
003 102__DVD  
004 103__DVD  
---  
---  
---  
---  
----  
----  
Page 01/01  
Picture 0012 File 0012  
Page 001/001  
Previous  
Next  
OK  
OK  
OPTION  
RETURN  
RETURN  
You can also select folders with the numbered buttons.  
e.g.,  
5:  
15:  
115:  
[0] [0] [5]  
[0] [1] [5]  
[1] [1] [5]  
[Note]  
When copying the still pictures on a folder by folder basis  
(56) or card by card basis (above, Copy All Pictures), files  
other than the still picture files inside the folder will also be  
copied. (This does not apply to the lower folders contained  
inside the folders.)  
If still pictures are already contained inside the copy destination  
folder, the new still pictures are recorded following the existing  
still pictures.  
If the space on the destination drive runs out or the number of  
files/folders to be copied exceeds the maximum (37), copying  
will stop partway through.  
When a name has not been input for the copy source folder, the  
folder’s name may be changed from the source folder. It is  
recommended that you input a folder name before copying  
(49, Enter Album Name).  
The still pictures of different folders cannot be registered on the  
same list.  
To switch to another higher folder  
Only when selecting the source folder  
If there is a multiple number of higher  
\DCIM\100__DVD  
folders recognizable, while the screen on  
the right appears  
001 100__DVD  
002 101__DVD  
003 102__DVD  
004 103__DVD  
1 Press [OPTION] and press [OK].  
2 Press [2, 1] to select the higher  
Select Folder  
folder and press [OK].  
You cannot register a folder with a  
different higher folder to the same  
Select folder to access.  
\DCIM  
Press OK to set.  
SELECT  
list.  
RETURN  
OK  
3 Press [3, 4] to select the desired  
folder and press [OK].  
You cannot copy the information about the picture rotation.  
The sequence in which the still pictures are registered on the  
copy list may not be the same at the copy destination.  
RQT8859  
57  
Copying from a video cassette recorder  
Í
Í
2 Start play on the other equipment.  
VOL  
CH  
DRIVE  
SELECT  
AV  
DRIVE  
SELECT  
PAGE  
CH  
3
When you want to start recording  
2 3  
1
Press [¥ REC].  
4 5 6  
Recording starts.  
ANALOGUE  
CH  
8 9  
0
7
G-Code  
DELETE  
INPUT  
To skip unwanted parts  
Press [;] to pause recording. (Press again to restart recording.)  
SELECT  
INPUT SELECT  
SKIP  
SLOW/SEARCH  
To stop recording  
Press [].  
PAUSE  
PLAY/x1.3  
EXIT  
STOP  
;
Almost all videos and DVD-Video on sale have been treated  
to prevent illegal copying. Any software that has been so  
treated cannot be recorded using this unit.  
STATUS  
I
FUNCTION  
MENU  
Using Flexible Recording (27), you can record the content of a  
video cassette (approx. 1–8 hours) to a 4.7 GB disc with the best  
possible quality of recording without wasting disc space.  
OK  
3,4,2,1  
OPTION  
RETURN  
OK  
CREATE  
DISPLAY  
CHAPTER  
AUDIO  
REC  
MANUAL SKIP  
DV automatic recording (DV Auto Rec)  
REC MODE  
REC MODE TIME SLIP PROG/CHECK  
¥ REC  
[HDD] [RAM] [-R] [-RW‹V›] [+R] [+RW]  
e.g., Connecting to the AV3 or DV input terminals on the front  
[HDD] [RAM] When the “DV Auto Rec” function is used, programmes  
are recorded as a title while at the same time chapters are created at  
each break in the images and the playlist is created automatically.  
You can also connect to the AV4 input terminals on the rear.  
Turn off the unit and other video equipment before connecting.  
Preparation  
1
Turn off the main unit and DV equipment, then connect the  
equipment with the unit’s DV input terminal (left column).  
Turn on the main unit and DV equipment.  
Press [REC MODE] to select the recording mode.  
Pause play of the DV equipment at the point you want recording  
to start.  
REC  
OPEN/CLOSE  
2
3
4
This unit  
DV IN  
VIDEO  
L/MONO - AUDIO- R  
S VIDEO  
AV3 IN  
When the output signal from the external equipment is NTSC,  
Yellow White Red  
change the “TV System” to “NTSC” in the Setup menu (72).  
After preparation is completed, the following screen appears.  
DV Auto Rec  
DV cable  
(IEEE 1394, 4-pin)  
Press [2, 1] to select “Rec to  
HDD” or “Rec to DVD” and press  
[OK].  
DV unit is connected.  
Record from the DV unit?  
S Video  
cable§  
Audio/Video  
cable  
Other video equipment  
Rec to HDD  
Rec to DVD  
Cancel  
You can proceed to step 4.  
SELECT  
RETURN  
OK  
Connect to Audio/Video output terminals.  
When the screen is not displayed, press [DRIVE SELECT] to select  
If the audio output of the other equipment is monaural  
Connect to L/MONO on the AV3 input terminals at the front.  
§ The S VIDEO terminal achieves a more vivid picture than the  
VIDEO terminal.  
HDD or DVD and then continue from step 1.  
1
While stopped  
When recording from the unit’s DV terminal  
Select the type of audio recording from “Audio Mode for DV Input”  
in the Setup menu (66).  
When recording from DV equipment (e.g., digital video camcorder),  
you can record audio/video recordings from DV tape only.  
When “Rec for High Speed Copy” (65) is set to “On” and you  
make a copy, the copy will be made using the picture size selected  
in “Aspect for Recording” (65) of the Setup menu.  
Press [FUNCTION MENU].  
2 Press [3, 4] to select “To Others”  
and press [OK].  
3 Press [3, 4] to select “DV Auto Rec”  
and press [OK].  
About the aspect when recording a programme (8)  
4 Press [2, 1] to select “Rec” and  
[Note]  
If it becomes time for a timer recording to start while copying, the  
recording will start and the copying will stop.  
press [OK].  
Recording starts.  
Manual recording  
[HDD] [RAM] [-R] [-RW‹V›] [+R] [+RW]  
Preparation  
When recording finishes  
The confirmation screen appears. Press [OK] to finish DV automatic  
recording.  
Press [DRIVE SELECT] to select the HDD or DVD drive.  
Press [REC MODE] to select the recording mode.  
When recording bilingual programmes (8, Selecting Audio for  
Recording)  
When the output signal from the external equipment is NTSC,  
change the “TV System” to “NTSC” in the Setup menu (72).  
This unit cannot record NTSC signals to discs that already have  
PAL signal recordings. (However, both types of programmes can  
be recorded onto the HDD.)  
To stop recording  
Press [].  
[Note]  
Only one piece of DV equipment (e.g., digital video camcorder) can  
be connected to the unit via the DV input terminal.  
It is not possible to operate the unit from the connected DV equipment.  
The DV input on this unit is for use with DV equipment only. (It  
cannot be connected to a computer, etc.)  
The DV equipment name may not be shown correctly.  
Depending on the DV equipment, the images or audio may not be  
input properly.  
The date and time information on the tape of the DV equipment will  
not be recorded.  
You cannot record and play simultaneously.  
To reduce noise in input from a video cassette recorder, set “AV-in  
NR” to “On” in the on-screen menu (43).  
Check the time on the unit is correct.  
1
While stopped  
Press [INPUT SELECT] to select the  
input channel for the equipment you  
If the DV automatic recording function does not work properly,  
check the connections and DV equipment settings, and turn the  
unit off and back on.  
If that does not work, follow the instructions for manual  
recording (left column).  
RQT8859  
have connected.  
e.g., If you have connected to AV3 input terminals, select “A3”.  
58  
Entering text  
VOL  
CH  
DRIVE  
SELECT  
AV  
2 Press [3, 4, 2, 1] to select a  
PAGE  
CH  
2 3  
4 5 6  
1
character and press [OK].  
Numbered  
buttons  
Repeat this step to enter other characters.  
ANALOGUE  
CH  
To delete a character  
Press [3, 4, 2, 1] to select the character in the name field  
and press [;]. (The selected characters are deleted.)  
8 9  
7
G-Code  
DELETE  
INPUT  
0
SELECT  
DELETE  
¢
t
x
SKIP  
SLOW/SEARCH  
Using the numbered buttons to enter characters  
PAUSE  
PLAY/x1.3  
EXIT  
STOP  
;
e.g., entering the letter “R”  
ingte  
r
e
STATUS  
1 Press [7] to move to the 7th  
5
J
K
N
Q
U
L
O
R
V
I
row.  
7
7
/Ent  
2 Press [7] twice to highlight  
“R”.  
3 Press [OK].  
6 M  
r
e
7
OK  
d
r
P
T
7
o
c
e
3,4,2,1  
OPTION  
RETURN  
To enter a space  
Press [DELETE ¢] and press  
[OK].  
OK  
8
RETURN  
CREATE  
r
e
t
t
[HDD] [RAM] [-R] [-R]DL] [-RW‹V›] [+R] [+R]DL] [+RW] [SD]  
e
s
s
a
You can give names to recorded titles, etc.  
The maximum number of characters:  
[HDD] [RAM]  
3 Press [] (Set).  
“Writing...” appears then the screen returns to the Title view  
screen and so on.  
Characters  
64 (44§)  
oc  
Title  
de  
i
v
Playlist  
64  
To end partway  
Press [RETURN].  
Text is not added.  
Album of still pictures  
36  
oma  
Disc ([RAM])  
64  
r
f
§ Title name for timer recording  
ing  
y
[-R] [-R]DL] [-RW‹V›] [+R] [+R]DL] [+RW]  
Characters  
For your reference  
Title  
Disc  
44  
40  
Cop  
If you enter a long name, only part of it is shown in the Top Menu  
after finalisation (62). When entering a title name, the name that  
will appear in the Top Menu can be previewed in “Top Menu Preview”  
window.  
[SD]  
Characters  
36  
Album of still pictures  
Enter Name  
Chapter 1_  
_
Broadcast  
Characters  
14  
1
2
3
4
1
A
D
G
2
B
E
H
3
C
F
I
4
5
a
d
g
6
b
e
h
7
c
f
8
i
/
9
j
l
$
0
Top Menu Preview  
Chapter 1  
Favourite group 1-4  
*
%
[Note]  
i
&
If a name is long, parts of it may not be shown in some screens.  
1 Show Enter Name screen.  
Title (timer recording)  
Select “Programme Name” in step 3 on page 31.  
Title  
Select “Enter Name” in step 5 on page 44.  
Playlist  
Select “Enter Name” in step 5 on page 47.  
Disc  
Select “Disc Name” in step 4 of “Providing a name for a  
disc” on page 60.  
Album of still pictures  
Select “Enter Album Name” in step 4 on page 48, “To edit  
the album”.  
Favourite group 1-4  
Press the “Red” button in step 2 right column on page 69,  
To change the name of a group in the “Favourite” column”.  
Name field: shows the text you have entered  
Enter Name  
_
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
0
1
A
D
G
J
2
B
E
H
K
N
Q
U
X
,
3
C
F
I
4
5
a
6
b
e
7
c
f
8
/
9
$
0
Top Menu Preview  
*
d
g
j
%
h
k
i
7
[
&
@
_
L
O
R
V
Y
?
l
]
Delete  
m
n
o
M
P
T
Set  
S
p
t
q
u
x
'
r
s
{
(
)
-
v
}
W
.
Z
!
w
"
y
:
z
;
|
\
ꢁꢁ  
0
9
^
`
SELECT  
Space  
RETURN  
OK  
RQT8859  
59  
HDD, disc and card management  
Setting the protection  
[RAM]  
DVD  
TV  
Í
Í
VOL  
CH  
Preparation  
DRIVE  
SELECT  
AV  
Press [DRIVE SELECT] to select the DVD drive.  
DRIVE  
SELECT  
PAGE  
CH  
2 3  
1
After performing steps 1–3 (left)  
4 5 6  
ANALOGUE  
CH  
4 Press [3, 4] to select “Disc  
8 9  
7
G-Code  
DELETE  
INPUT  
0
SELECT  
Protection” and press [OK].  
SKIP  
SLOW/SEARCH  
5 Press [2, 1] to select “Yes” and  
PAUSE  
PLAY/x1.3  
EXIT  
STOP  
press [OK].  
STATUS  
DVD  
EXIT  
I
Titles  
Used  
11  
0 : 22  
Remain 5:38 (EP)  
Management  
DVD-RAM  
Disc Name  
FUNCTION  
MENU  
OK  
Disc Protection  
Delete all titles  
On  
OPTION  
RETURN  
3,4,2,1  
SELECT  
RETURN  
OK  
CREATE  
OK  
DISPLAY  
CHAPTER  
Format Disc  
AUDIO  
REC  
MANUAL SKIP  
RETURN  
REC MODE TIME SLIP PROG/CHECK  
The lock symbol appears closed when the disc is write-  
protected.  
To return to the previous screen  
Press [RETURN].  
To exit the screen  
Press [EXIT].  
[HDD] [RAM] [-R] [-R]DL] [-RW‹V›] [+R] [+R]DL] [+RW] [-RW‹VR›] [SD]  
You can use SD Cards with capacities from 8 MB to 4 GB (7).  
Cartridge-protection  
Common procedures  
For a DVD-RAM with a cartridge  
With the write-protect tab in the protect position,  
1
While stopped  
play automatically starts when inserted in the  
unit.  
PROTECT  
Press [FUNCTION MENU].  
[SD]  
2 Press [3, 4] to select “To Others”  
Switch the write-protect switch to the “LOCK”  
position.  
and press [OK].  
FUNCTION MENU  
HDD  
Remain 30:00 SP  
Timer Recording  
G-Code Record  
Playback  
Recording  
Advanced Copy  
Playlists  
Delete  
Copy  
Flexible Rec  
DV Auto Rec  
Providing a name for a disc  
To Others  
OK  
Setup  
[RAM] [-R] [-R]DL] [-RW‹V›] [+R] [+R]DL] [+RW]  
RETURN  
HDD Management  
You can provide a name for each disc.  
3 Press [3, 4] to select “HDD  
Preparation  
Press [DRIVE SELECT] to select the DVD drive.  
[RAM] Release protection (above).  
Management”, “DVD Management” or  
“Card Management” and press [OK].  
e.g., [RAM]  
After performing steps 1–3 (left)  
DVD  
Titles  
Used  
11  
0 : 22  
Remain 5:38 (EP)  
Management  
4 Press [3, 4] to select “Disc Name”  
and press [OK].  
DVD-RAM  
Disc Name  
Disc Protection  
Delete all titles  
Off  
(59, Entering text)  
SELECT  
OK  
Format Disc  
The disc name is displayed in the DVD Management window.  
[-R] [-R]DL] [-RW‹V›] [+R] [+R]DL] With a finalised disc, the name is  
displayed on the Top Menu.  
[+RW] The disc name is displayed only if you play the disc on other  
equipment.  
RETURN  
When HDD has been selected, “Delete all titles” and  
“Format HDD” are displayed.  
When SD has been selected, “Format Card” only is  
displayed.  
Documentary  
My favorite  
01/02  
DVD  
Management  
DVD-RAM  
Titles  
Used  
11  
0 : 22  
Remain 5:38 (  
01  
Chapter  
02  
Chapter  
1
2
To return to the previous screen  
Press [RETURN].  
To exit the screen  
Press [EXIT].  
RQT8859  
60  
Deleting all titles and playlists—Delete  
all titles  
Deleting all the contents of a disc or  
card—Format  
[HDD] [RAM]  
[HDD] [RAM] [-RW‹V›] [+RW] [-RW‹VR›] [SD]  
[+R] [+R]DL] (New disc only)  
Preparation  
Press [DRIVE SELECT] to select the HDD or DVD drive.  
Release protection (60).  
Preparation  
nt  
Press [DRIVE SELECT] to select the HDD, DVD or SD drive.  
Release protection (60).  
me  
e
g
After performing steps 1–3 (60)  
[Note]  
na  
4 Press [3, 4] to select “Delete all  
Formatting deletes all contents (including computer data),  
and they cannot be restored. Check carefully before  
proceeding. The contents are deleted when you format a disc or  
card even if you have set protection.  
ma  
titles” and press [OK].  
d
r
a
5 Press [2, 1] to select “Yes” and  
ndc  
press [OK].  
a
c
After performing steps 1–3 (60)  
6 Press [2, 1] to select “Start” and  
press [OK].  
,dis  
4 Press [3, 4] to select “Format HDD”,  
A message appears when finished.  
“Format Disc” or “Format Card” and  
press [OK].  
HD  
7 Press [OK].  
To return to the previous screen  
Press [RETURN].  
5 Press [2, 1] to select “Yes” and  
press [OK].  
To exit the screen  
Press [EXIT].  
6 Press [2, 1] to select “Start” and  
[Note]  
press [OK].  
Once deleted, the recorded contents are lost and cannot be  
restored. Make certain before proceeding.  
Deleting all video titles will result in all playlists also being deleted.  
Still picture data (JPEG) or computer data cannot be deleted.  
Delete does not work if one or more titles are protected.  
A message appears when formatting is finished.  
[Note]  
Formatting normally takes a few minutes; however, it may  
take up to a maximum of 70 minutes ([RAM]).  
Do not disconnect the AC mains lead while formatting.  
This can render the disc or the card unusable.  
7 Press [OK].  
[Note]  
When a disc or card has been formatted using this unit, it may not  
be possible to use it on any other equipment.  
[-R] [-R]DL] [CD] Formatting cannot be performed on the disc.  
You can format DVD-RW only as DVD-Video format on this unit.  
To stop formatting [RAM]  
Press [RETURN].  
You can cancel formatting if it takes more than 2 minutes. The disc  
must be reformatted if you do this.  
To return to the previous screen  
Press [RETURN].  
To exit the screen  
Press [EXIT].  
RQT8859  
61  
HDD, disc and card management  
Refer to the control reference on page 60.  
[Note]  
When finalising a high-speed recording compatible disc, it may take  
longer than displayed on the confirmation screen (approximately four  
times).  
Selecting the background style  
Top  
Menu  
[-R] [-R]DL] [-RW‹V›] [+R] [+R]DL] [+RW]  
After finalising  
You can select the background that will be displayed as the DVD-  
Video top menu after finalising or Create Top Menu ([+RW]).  
[-R] [-R]DL] [+R] [+R]DL] The disc becomes play-only and you  
can no longer record or edit.  
[-RW‹V›] You can record and edit the disc after formatting  
(61) although it becomes play-only after finalising.  
When copying in high speed, chapters will be replicated.  
[-R] [-RW‹V›] Titles are divided into about 5-minute ([+R] 8-  
minute)§ chapters, if  
–the titles were directly recorded to the disc.  
–the titles were copied using any mode other than the high  
speed mode (excluding [-R]DL] [+R]DL]).  
§ This time varies greatly depending on the condition and mode  
of recording.  
Preparation  
Press [DRIVE SELECT] to select the DVD drive.  
After performing steps 1–3 (60)  
4 Press [3, 4] to select “Top Menu”  
and press [OK].  
5 Press [3, 4, 2, 1] to select the  
background and press [OK].  
Top Menu List  
There is a pause of several seconds between titles and  
chapters during play.  
1
2
3
Display after finalising  
Thumbnail  
(Still picture)  
01  
Before  
finalising  
After  
finalising  
Title Name  
Recording/Editing/Entering name  
Play on other players  
You can change thumbnails displayed in the top menu. (45,  
Change Thumbnail)  
You cannot finalise discs recorded on other manufacturer’s  
equipment.  
If you finalise discs recorded on Panasonic equipment other than  
this unit, the background selected as “Top Menu” may not be  
displayed.  
Discs finalised on this unit may not be playable on other players  
due to the condition of the recording.  
Selecting whether to show the Top  
Menu first—Auto-Play Select  
[-R] [-R]DL] [-RW‹V›] [+R] [+R]DL] [+RW]  
You can select whether to show the top menu after finalising.  
Preparation  
Press [DRIVE SELECT] to select the DVD drive.  
Creating Top Menu—Create Top Menu  
After performing steps 1–3 (60)  
[+RW]  
4 Press [3, 4] to select “Auto-Play  
Select” and press [OK].  
+RW discs contain no Top Menu data. Top Menu is a convenient  
function. We recommend you create the menu before playing a +RW  
disc on other equipment.  
5 Press [3, 4] to select “Top Menu” or  
You cannot use the Top Menu for playing on this unit.  
“Title 1” and press [OK].  
Top Menu: The top menu appears first.  
Make selections from “Top Menu” and “Auto-Play Select” (left  
column) before creating top menu.  
Title 1:  
The disc content is played without displaying the  
top menu.  
Preparation  
Press [DRIVE SELECT] to select the DVD drive.  
Enabling discs to be played on other  
equipment—Finalise  
After performing steps 1–3 (60)  
[-R] [-R]DL] [-RW‹V›] [+R] [+R]DL]  
4 Press [3, 4] to select “Create Top  
Make selections from “Top Menu” and “Auto-Play Select” (above)  
before finalising the disc.  
Menu” and press [OK].  
Preparation  
Press [DRIVE SELECT] to select the DVD drive.  
5 Press [2, 1] to select “Yes” and  
After performing steps 1–3 (60)  
press [OK].  
4 Press [3, 4] to select “Finalise” and  
press [OK].  
6 Press [2, 1] to select “Start” and  
press [OK].  
Creating Top Menu starts. You cannot cancel creating.  
Creating Top Menu can take a few minutes.  
5 Press [2, 1] to select “Yes” and  
press [OK].  
7 Press [OK].  
6 Press [2, 1] to select “Start” and  
[Note]  
press [OK].  
You can record or edit discs after creating the Top Menu. But the  
created menu is deleted when you record or edit disc. In such  
cases, create the Top Menu again by using “Create Top Menu”.  
A message appears when finalising is finished.  
[Note]  
You cannot cancel finalising.  
Finalising takes up to 15 minutes.  
([-R]DL] [+R]DL] Finalising takes up to 60 minutes.)  
Do not disconnect the AC mains lead while finalising.  
This will render the disc unusable.  
7 Press [OK].  
To return to the previous screen  
Press [RETURN].  
RQT8859  
To exit the screen  
Press [EXIT].  
62  
FUNCTION MENU window  
By using the FUNCTION MENU window you may access the main  
functions quickly and easily.  
DVD  
TV  
1
While stopped  
Í
Í
Press [FUNCTION MENU].  
VOL  
CH  
DRIVE  
SELECT  
AV  
Functions displayed depend on the selected drive or type of  
disc.  
PAGE  
CH  
k
2 3  
1
FUNCTION MENU  
HDD  
Remain 70:00 SP  
4 5 6  
Playback  
ANALOGUE  
CH  
8 9  
7
Recording  
G-Code  
DELETE  
Delete  
Copy  
INPUT  
/ChildLoc  
0
SELECT  
SKIP  
w
o
d
SLOW/SEARCH  
To Others  
OK  
RETURN  
n
i
PAUSE  
PLAY/x1.3  
EXIT  
STOP  
w
STATUS  
I
NU  
2 Press [3, 4] to select an item and  
E
FUNCTION  
MENU  
press [OK].  
OK  
If you select “To Others” and press [OK], the following screen  
appears. Press [3, 4] to select an item and press [OK].  
If you press [RETURN], you can return to the previous  
screen.  
OPTION  
RETURN  
3,4,2,1  
RETURN  
OK  
CREATE  
CHAPTER  
DISPLAY  
AUDIO  
REC  
MANUAL SKIP  
REC MODE TIME SLIP PROG/CHECK  
To exit the FUNCTION MENU window  
Press [FUNCTION MENU].  
ment/FUCTIONM  
dmnage  
car  
d
n
sca  
di  
,
Child Lock  
D
HD  
The Child Lock deactivates all buttons on the unit and remote  
control. Use it to prevent other people from operating the unit.  
Press and hold [OK] and  
[RETURN]  
DVD  
TV  
Í
Í
VOL  
CH  
DRIVE  
SELECT  
AV  
simultaneously until “X  
HOLD” appears on the unit’s display.  
PAGE  
CH  
2 3  
1
4 5 6  
If you press a button while the Child Lock is on, “X HOLD” appears  
on the unit’s display and operation is impossible.  
ANALOGUE  
CH  
8 9  
7
G-Code  
DELETE  
INPUT  
0
SELECT  
SKIP  
SLOW/SEARCH  
To cancel the Child Lock  
Press and hold [OK] and [RETURN] simultaneously until “X HOLD”  
disappears.  
PAUSE  
PLAY/x1.3  
EXIT  
STOP  
STATUS  
I
OK  
OK  
OPTION  
RETURN  
RETURN  
CREATE  
CHAPTER  
DISPLAY  
AUDIO  
MANUAL SKIP  
RQT8859  
63  
Changing the unit’s settings  
Common procedures  
W
X
CH  
1
While stopped  
REC  
OPEN/CLOSE  
Press [FUNCTION MENU].  
2 Press [3, 4] to select “To Others”  
and press [OK].  
< OPEN/CLOSE  
3 Press [3, 4] to select “Setup” and  
DVD  
press [OK].  
TV  
Í
Í
VOL  
CH  
4 Press [3, 4] to select the tab and  
DRIVE  
SELECT  
AV  
PAGE  
CH  
press [1].  
2 3  
4 5 6  
1
Menus  
Options  
Tabs  
W X  
CH  
Numbered  
buttons  
Setup  
ANALOGUE  
CH  
Comb Filter  
Still Mode  
Seamless Play  
On  
Automatic  
On  
8 9  
7
G-Code  
DELETE  
INPUT  
0
SELECT  
Tuning  
SKIP  
SLOW/SEARCH  
Disc  
Picture  
Sound  
Display  
Connection  
Others  
PAUSE  
PLAY/x1.3  
EXIT  
STOP  
TAB  
SELECT  
OK  
STATUS  
RETURN  
EXIT  
I
5 Press [3, 4] to select the menu and  
FUNCTION  
MENU  
OK  
press [OK].  
3,4,2,1  
OPTION  
RETURN  
6 Press [3, 4] to select the option and  
OK  
RETURN  
CREATE  
DISPLAY  
CHAPTER  
AUDIO  
REC  
MANUAL SKIP  
press [OK].  
“Red”  
“Green”  
“Blue”  
“Yellow”  
REC MODE TIME SLIP PROG/CHECK  
To return to the previous screen  
Press [RETURN].  
To exit the screen  
Press [EXIT].  
Summary of settings  
The settings remain intact even if you switch the unit to standby.  
Tabs  
Menus  
Options (Underlined items are the factory presets.)  
Edit Favourites (69)  
You can edit terrestrial digital or analogue channels into different  
four categories.  
Tuning  
Auto-Setup Restart (72)  
You can restart the channel settings for terrestrial digital and  
analogue channels.  
Settings for Digital Services  
Press [OK] to show the following settings.  
DVB Manual Tuning (70)  
Add New DVB Services (69)  
Signal Condition (70)  
You can set channels manually that the DVB Auto Setup could  
not complete successfully.  
You can search for newly added terrestrial digital channels to  
receive.  
You can check the condition of digital broadcast signals.  
You can delete channels and set analogue channel details.  
Settings for Analogue Services  
Press [OK] to show the following settings.  
Manual Tuning (71)  
RQT8859  
64  
Tabs  
Disc  
Menus  
Options (Underlined items are the factory presets.)  
Settings for Playback  
Press [OK] to show the following settings.  
Ratings  
8 No Limit: All DVD-Video can be played.  
Set a ratings level to limit DVD-Video play.  
1 to 7:  
Prohibits play of DVD-Video with corresponding  
ratings recorded on them.  
Follow the on-screen instructions. Enter a 4-digit password  
with the numbered buttons when the password screen is  
shown.  
0 Lock All: Prohibits play of all DVD-Video.  
tings  
e
Unlock Recorder  
Change Password  
Temporary Unlock  
s
s
Change Level  
Do not forget your password.  
Soundtrack Choose the language for audio, subtitle and  
English  
German  
French Italian  
unit’  
disc menus. [DVD-V]  
Spanish  
Some discs start in a certain language despite Original: The original language of each disc will be selected.  
any changes you make here.  
Other ¢¢¢¢  
Enter a code (73) with the numbered  
buttons when you select “Other ¢¢¢¢”.  
When the selected language is not available  
on the disc, the default language is played.  
There are discs where you can only switch the  
language from the menu screen (35).  
Subtitle  
Menus  
Automatic: If the language selected for “Soundtrack” is not  
available, subtitles of that language will  
ingthe  
n
automatically appear if available on that disc.  
English  
German  
French  
Italian  
Cha  
Spanish  
Other ¢¢¢¢  
English  
German  
French  
Italian  
Spanish  
Other ¢¢¢¢  
Settings for Recording  
Press [OK] to show the following settings.  
Recording time in EP mode  
EP (6 Hours):You can record for 6 hours on an unused 4.7 GB  
Select the maximum number of hours for recording in EP  
mode (25, Recording modes and approximate recording  
times).  
disc.  
EP (8 Hours):You can record for 8 hours on an unused 4.7 GB  
disc.  
The sound quality is better when using “EP (6 Hours)” than when  
using “EP (8 Hours)”.  
Aspect for Recording  
Sets the aspect ratio when recording or copying.  
When recording or copying to the HDD or DVD-RAM with  
Automatic: The programme will be recorded in the original  
aspect used when recording started (including when  
recording started at a commercial, etc.).  
“Rec for High Speed Copy” set to “Off”, programme will be 16:9  
recorded in the original aspect ratio.  
4:3  
In the following cases, even when set to “Automatic” or “16:9”,  
recordings will be made or copied in 4:3.  
[-R] [-R]DL] [-RW‹V›] When the recording mode is set to “EP” or  
“FR (recordings 5 hours or longer)” mode.  
–When recording or copying to a +R, +R DL and +RW.  
Rec for High Speed Copy  
On: You can high-speed copy to DVD-R, etc. Press [2, 1] to  
select “Yes” and press [OK].  
You can copy recorded titles from the HDD to DVD-R,  
DVD-R DL, DVD-RW (DVD-Video format), +R, +R DL and  
+RW using high speed mode. However, screen size, etc. is  
restricted (right).  
The following restrictions are applied to recorded titles.  
–Recordings are made using the aspect ratio set in  
“Aspect for Recording” (above).  
We recommend turning the setting “Off” if high speed copy to  
DVD-R, etc. is not necessary when recording a programme.  
This setting is effective when recording from a television  
programme or external equipment (including DV equipment),  
or when copying from a finalised DVD-Video disc.  
–Select the type of audio in advance from “Bilingual  
Audio Selection” (66).  
You are no longer able to switch the audio when watching  
a programme on an input channel on the TV connected to  
this unit.  
Off (26)  
DVD Speed for High Speed Copy  
Maximum  
Select the speed of high-speed copying (When using high-  
Normal (Silent):  
speed copy compatible DVD-RAM 5X, DVD-R, +R 8X or +RW Selecting “Normal (Silent)” means the noise generated by this  
4X discs).  
unit is less than “Maximum”, however the time required for  
copying will double (approximately).  
(continued on the next page)  
RQT8859  
65  
Changing the unit’s settings  
(continued)  
Refer to the control reference on page 64.  
Tabs  
Menus  
Options (Underlined items are the factory presets.)  
Comb Filter  
On: Pictures become clear and vivid. Normally, use this setting.  
Off: Select it when recording noisy pictures.  
Picture  
Select the picture sharpness when recording.  
The setting is fixed with “On” if you set “TV System” to “NTSC”  
(72).  
Still Mode  
Automatic  
Field: Select if jittering occurs when “Automatic” is selected.  
(The picture is coarser.)  
Frame: Select if small text or fine patterns cannot be seen  
clearly when “Automatic” is selected. (The picture is  
clearer and finer.)  
Select the type of picture shown when you pause play  
(84, Frames and fields).  
Seamless Play  
Select the play mode between playlist chapter segments and  
partially deleted titles.  
On: The chapters in playlists are played seamlessly. This does  
not work when there are several audio types included on  
the playlist and when using Quick View (Play x1.3).  
Additionally, the positioning of chapter segments may  
change slightly.  
Off: The points where chapters in playlists change are played  
accurately, but the picture may freeze for a moment.  
Dynamic Range Compression [DVD-V] (Dolby Digital only)  
Change the dynamic range for late night viewing.  
On  
Off  
Sound  
Bilingual Audio Selection  
(Analogue broadcast only)  
M 1  
M 2  
Select whether to record the main or secondary audio type  
when:  
You cannot select the audio on this unit when recording from an  
external source, such as when copying from a video cassette  
–Recording or copying to a DVD-R, DVD-R DL, DVD-RW (DVD- recorder (except from DV equipment connected to this unit’s DV  
Video format), +R, +R DL and +RW.  
–“Rec for High Speed Copy” is set to “On”.  
input terminal). Select the audio on the other equipment.  
When recording from the unit’s DV terminal, select the type of  
–Recording or copying sound in LPCM (below, “Audio Mode audio recording from “Audio Mode for DV Input” (below).  
for XP Recording”).  
Digital Audio Output  
Change the settings when you have connected equipment through this unit’s DIGITAL AUDIO OUT terminal (16).  
Press [OK] to show the following settings.  
PCM Down Conversion  
Select how to output audio with a sampling frequency of 96  
kHz or 88.2 kHz.  
Signals are converted to 48 kHz or 44.1 kHz despite the  
settings across if the signals have a sampling frequency of  
over 96 kHz or 88.2 kHz, or the disc has copy protection.  
On: Signals are converted to 48 kHz or 44.1 kHz. (Choose  
when the connected equipment cannot process signals  
with a sampling frequency of 96 kHz or 88.2 kHz.)  
Off: Signals are output as 96 kHz or 88.2 kHz. (Choose when  
the connected equipment can process signals with a  
sampling frequency of 96 kHz or 88.2 kHz.)  
Dolby Digital  
Select how to output the signal.  
Select “Bitstream” if the connected  
equipment decodes the signal.  
Select “PCM” if this unit decodes  
the signal and outputs it as 2  
channels.  
Bitstream:When connecting to equipment displaying the Dolby  
Digital logo.  
PCM: When connecting to equipment not displaying the Dolby  
Digital logo.  
DTS  
Bitstream: When connecting to equipment displaying the DTS  
logo.  
PCM: When connecting to equipment not displaying the DTS  
[Note]  
Not making the proper settings may  
result in noise or some trouble for  
digital recording.  
logo.  
MPEG  
Bitstream: When connected to equipment with a built-in  
MPEG decoder.  
PCM: When connected to equipment without a built-in MPEG  
decoder.  
Audio Mode for XP Recording  
Dolby Digital (84)  
Choose the audio type when recording or copying with XP  
mode.  
LPCM (85)  
–The picture quality of LPCM recordings may be lower than  
that of normal XP mode recordings.  
–The audio recording becomes Dolby Digital even if you  
selected LPCM when using a recording mode other than XP.  
–When recording a bilingual broadcast, select the type of  
audio in advance from “Bilingual Audio Selection” (above).  
Audio Mode for DV Input  
Stereo 1: Records audio (L1, R1).  
You can select the kind of audio when recording from the unit’s Stereo 2: Records added audio such as narration (L2, R2)  
DV input terminal (58).  
subsequent to original recording.  
Records both Stereo 1 and Stereo 2.  
Mix:  
When recording bilingual broadcast, select the type of audio in  
advance from “Bilingual Audio Selection” (above).  
RQT8859  
66  
Tabs  
Menus  
Options (Underlined items are the factory presets.)  
On-Screen Messages  
Choose the approximate time until the digital channel information  
screen (23) disappears automatically.  
Off: The digital channel information is not displayed.  
Display  
3 sec.  
5 sec.  
7 sec.  
10 sec.  
The length of time the control panel (19) is displayed can also  
be changed, but “Off” does not work.  
Grey Background  
Select “Off” if you do not want to have the unit show the grey  
background when tuner reception is weak.  
On  
Off  
tings  
FL Display  
Bright  
Dim  
e
Automatic: The display turns dark during play and disappears  
when the unit is turned off. It reappears momentarily  
if a button is pressed. While using this mode, the  
standby power consumption can be reduced.  
Changes the brightness of the unit’s display.  
This setting is fixed with “Automatic” if you set “Power Save”  
(68) to “On”.  
s
s
unit’  
New Service Message (23)  
Automatic  
When a new DVB channel is added this unit will be informed  
automatically. Then the confirmation message appears. If you  
select “Yes” on the display, Auto-Setup starts (all channel  
settings and all created categories are deleted. The timer  
recording programmes are also cancelled.).  
Off: The service messages are not shown.  
ingthe  
n
TV Aspect (20)  
Set to match the type of 16:9: When connected to a 16:9 widescreen television.  
Cha  
Connection  
Pan & Scan:  
television connected.  
When connected to a 4:3 aspect television, side  
picture is trimmed for 16:9 picture (85).  
Letterbox:  
When connected to a 4:3 aspect television.  
16:9 picture is shown in the letterbox style (85).  
Progressive (21)  
On  
Off  
This setting is fixed with “Off” if you set  
AV1 Output” to “RGB 1 (without  
component)” or “RGB 2 (without  
component)”.  
TV System (72)  
PAL  
NTSC  
HDMI Settings§  
Press [OK] to show the following settings.  
HDMI Video Format  
576i/480i  
720p  
1080p:  
576p/480p  
1080i  
You can only select items compatible with the connected  
equipment. This setting normally does not need to be  
changed. However if you are concerned about output picture  
quality, it may be improved by changing the setting.  
When setting video output to “1080p”, we  
recommend using a Panasonic HDMI cable 5  
meters or less in length to prevent video distortion.  
To enjoy High Quality Video up-converted to 1080p,  
you need to connect the unit to 1080p compatible  
HDTV.  
Automatic: Automatically selects the output resolution best  
suited to the connected television (1080p, 1080i,  
720p, 576p/480p or 576i/480i).  
Aspect for 4:3 Video  
4:3:  
Picture output expands left or right.  
To play a 4:3 title when connected with an HDMI cable, set  
how to show pictures on a 16:9 widescreen television.  
16:9: Picture is output as original aspect with  
side panels.  
Digital Audio Output  
HDMI and Optical  
Optical Only: Select when this unit is connected to an amplifier  
with an optical digital audio cable and connected  
to a TV with an HDMI cable and you want to enjoy  
the highest quality of audio from discs (16).  
VIERA Link  
On  
Set to use “HDAVI Control” function when connected with an  
HDMI cable to a device that supports “HDAVI Control”.  
Off: Select when you do not want to use “HDAVI Control”.  
AV1 Output  
Video (with component):  
Select when a TV is connected that can receive a composite  
signal.  
Selects the output from the AV1 terminal.  
Select “Video (with component)” or “S Video (with component)”  
for component output (progressive output).  
Set according to the terminal of the connected TV.  
S Video (with component):  
Select when a TV is connected that can receive an S Video  
signal.  
RGB 1 (without component):  
Select when a TV is connected that can receive an RGB signal.  
If you always would like to view the picture from the unit in RGB  
signal, select this mode. The TV screen will automatically  
switch to display the picture from the unit when the unit is  
turned on.  
If this unit is connected with an HDMI cable, you cannot select  
“RGB 1 (without component)” or “RGB 2 (without component)”.  
RGB 2 (without component):  
Select when a TV is connected that can receive an RGB signal.  
If you would like to switch to display the picture from the unit  
only when playback or viewing menus, select this mode.  
AV2 Input  
Video  
S Video  
This setting is according to the output signal of the connected  
equipment.  
§
Depending on the connected equipment, some items may be shaded in grey on the display and cannot be selected, or you may not be able to  
RQT8859  
change the settings.  
(continued on the next page)  
67  
Changing the unit’s settings  
(continued)  
Refer to the control reference on page 64.  
Tabs  
Menus  
Options (Underlined items are the factory presets.)  
Remote Control (22)  
Clock (73)  
DVD 1  
DVD 2  
DVD 3  
Others  
Power Save  
On: Power consumption is minimized when the unit is turned to  
Refer to the following when “Power Save” is set to “On”.  
–“FL Display” is automatically set to “Automatic” (67).  
–The “Quick Start” function does not work. (It is automatically  
turned to “Off”.)  
standby (86).  
Off  
If “Quick Start” is set to “On”, “Power Save” is automatically  
turned to “Off”.  
Quick Start  
On  
The Quick Start feature enables this unit to be ready to start  
recording as quick as approx. 1 second§ after turning it on. You  
can start recording soon after deciding you want to record  
something.  
Off:  
Standby power consumption is less than when this is set  
to “On”.  
§Only when recording to the HDD or DVD-RAM.  
If this is set to “On”, “Power Save” is automatically turned to  
“Off”.  
Startup takes up to a minute when:  
You play a disc or start recording to discs other than  
DVD-RAM.  
You want to make other operations.  
–The clock has not been set.  
DivX Registration  
You need this registration code to purchase and play DivX  
Video-on-Demand (VOD) content (39).  
System Update  
Update data and EPG download information is sent by an  
unscheduled digital broadcast. In order to receive these  
updates, you must be able to receive digital broadcasts.  
An update will take approximately 60 minutes. While the update  
is in progress, “SW-DL” appears on the unit’s display. You  
cannot operate the unit until the update is complete. Removing  
the AC mains lead while the update is in progress may damage  
the unit.  
In order to update this unit’s software, the EPG download, and to  
support system changes made by broadcasts, this unit  
periodically performs software updates.  
Press [OK] to show the following settings.  
An EPG download will take approximately 60 minutes. While  
the EPG download is in progress, “GUIDE” appears on the  
unit’s display. The EPG download can be interrupted by  
switching on the unit, since the download will continue in the  
background.  
EPG Download in Standby  
Software Update in Standby  
On: When you set this unit to standby mode, EPG data is  
downloaded automatically.  
Off  
On: When you set this unit to standby mode, software updates  
are downloaded automatically.  
Off  
EPG/Software search period  
Automatic:  
The unit will give priority to searching for EPG  
download and update data at midnight.  
Selects the time to automatically perform EPG download and  
updates when the unit is set to standby mode. This can only  
be set when “EPG Download in Standby” and “Software  
Update in Standby” is set to “On”.  
If there is a programmed recording set for the time you have  
selected, the programmed recording will be given priority.  
02:00–06:00  
06:00–10:00  
10:00–14:00  
14:00–18:00  
18:00–22:00  
22:00–02:00  
Software Update Search Now  
Start the search for new software manually.  
If applicable update data is found, press [2, 1] to select “Yes”  
and press [OK].  
A new software version is announced by a message. Do not  
turn your unit off during the update. This could result in the  
loss of data. A message shows that the update has finished.  
If a new software version is not going to be broadcast for the  
next few days, a corresponding message also appears.  
Initialize  
Press [OK] to show the following settings.  
Shipping Condition  
Yes  
All the settings except for the ratings level, ratings password No  
and clock settings return to the factory preset. The timer  
recording programmes are also cancelled.  
Default Settings  
Yes  
All the settings other than the tuning settings, clock settings, No  
time zone settings, disc language settings, ratings level,  
ratings password, remote control code, return to the factory  
presets.  
RQT8859  
68  
To delete channels on a group  
Tuning  
After performing steps 1–6  
§
1Press [1] .  
1
While stopped  
2Press [3, 4] to select the channel in the  
Press [FUNCTION MENU].  
“Favourite” column and press the “Yellow”  
button.  
Repeat this step to delete other channels.  
Press the “Blue” button to delete all the channels from the  
group.  
2 Press [3, 4] to select “To Others”  
and press [OK].  
tings  
3 Press [3, 4] to select “Setup” and  
e
3Press [OK] to save the group.  
Deleting a channel from a group does not affect the channel  
itself. You can still select the channel from the “All Services”  
group.  
s
s
press [OK].  
4 Press [3, 4] to select “Tuning” and  
unit’  
press [1].  
To change the name of a group in the  
“Favourite” column  
Setup  
Edit Favourites  
After performing steps 1–6  
Auto-Setup Restart  
ingthe  
Settings for Digital Services  
§
n
1Press [1] .  
Tuning  
Settings for Analogue Services  
Disc  
2Press the “Red” button.  
Picture  
Sound  
Cha  
(59, Entering text)  
Display  
Connection  
Others  
TAB  
§ When the station name of the “All Services” column is highlighted  
SELECT  
RETURN  
OK  
To browse through the list  
Press [W X CH].  
Edit Favourites  
You can create four groups of channels for making viewing and  
recording easier. Editing these groups does not affect the channel  
setting itself.  
To exit the screen  
Press [EXIT].  
Timer recording may not work correctly if you edit the groups  
during timer recording standby.  
Add New DVB Services  
You can search for newly added terrestrial digital channels to  
receive.  
After performing steps 1–4  
5 Press [3, 4] to select “Edit  
Favourites” and press [OK].  
After performing steps 1–4  
5 Press [3, 4] to select “Settings for  
Digital Services” and press [OK].  
6 Press the “Green” button to select the  
group.  
6 Press [3, 4] to select “Add New DVB  
Edit Favourites  
Services” and press [OK].  
All Services  
2A ABC  
Favourites 1  
The unit starts searching for newly available terrestrial digital  
channels. This takes about 5 minutes.  
20A ABC HDTV  
Add New DVB Services  
Please wait!  
Ch 6  
69  
Prog. Channel  
Service Name  
Net ID TS ID Quality  
Favourite Select  
Add  
Add All  
SELECT  
Page +  
Page -  
RETURN  
To add channels to a group  
After performing steps 1–6  
RETURN: to cancel  
1Press [3, 4] to select the channel in the “All  
Services” column and press the “Yellow”  
RETURN  
A message is displayed when the search is finished.  
“No new services found.” is displayed when no new services  
can be found.  
button.  
Repeat this step to add other channels.  
Press the “Blue” button to add all the available channels to the  
group. (Only when no channels have been added to the group.)  
7 Press [OK] to save the newly found  
channels.  
2Press [OK] to save the group.  
To change the order of channels of a group  
After performing steps 1–6  
To stop partway  
Press [RETURN].  
§
1Press [1] .  
2Press [3, 4] to select the channel in the  
“Favourite” column to move and press the  
“Green” button.  
The channels found before stopping are not saved.  
To exit the screen  
Press [EXIT].  
3Press [3, 4] to select the new position of the  
channel and press the “Green” button.  
Repeat the steps 2 3 to move other channels.  
4Press [OK] to save the group.  
RQT8859  
69  
Changing the unit’s settings  
Refer to the control reference on page 64.  
Signal Condition  
DVB Manual Tuning  
You can set channels manually that the DVB Auto Setup could not  
complete successfully.  
After performing steps 1–4 (69)  
You can check the quality and strength of digital broadcast signals.  
Realign the aerial if you are receiving a poor signal.  
When “Signal Condition” is displayed in grey and cannot be  
selected:  
1 Press [EXIT] to exit the screen.  
2 Press [W X CH] to select a digital channel. “D” appears on the  
unit’s display.  
3 Display the Setup menu again (69).  
5 Press [3, 4] to select “Settings for  
Digital Services” and press [OK].  
6 Press [3, 4] to select “DVB Manual  
Tuning” and press [OK].  
After performing steps 1–4 (69)  
DVB Manual Tuning  
Channel System  
Frequency  
Signal Quality  
Signal Strength  
Australia  
DVB CH24  
5 Press [3, 4] to select “Settings for  
Digital Services” and press [OK].  
498,0 MHz  
10  
10  
0
0
Prog. Channel Service Name  
Net ID TS ID Quality  
6 Press [3, 4] to select “Signal  
Condition” and press [OK].  
START SCAN  
OFFSET  
The quality and strength of the signal are shown.  
CHANNEL  
RETURN  
Press [W X CH] to select the channel.  
7 Press [3, 4] to select the channel  
2 ABC 2W DVB CH30  
Signal Quality  
0
0
10  
10  
Signal Strength  
you want to set.  
CH +  
CH –  
RETURN  
8 Press [2, 1] to adjust the frequency.  
Signal Quality  
The frequency rises and falls in steps of 0.5 MHz.  
Adjust the frequency by checking the signal strength and  
signal quality displays.  
Below 2 (display red): The signal quality is so poor that there may  
be interference in the pictures and sound.  
2–5 (display orange): The signal quality is basically adequate, but  
brief interference in the pictures and sound  
[Refer to “Signal Condition” (left) for signal quality and  
signal strength.]  
is possible in isolated case.  
Over 5 (display green): Optimum picture and sound quality.  
9 Press [OK] to start scan.  
10TPhreessetsch[aEnnXelIiTs ]disapnlaydedpinrethse stab[leW. X CH] to  
Signal Strength  
The display for signal strength is grey. 0” means signal strength 0%,  
“10” means signal strength 100%.  
If the signal is too strong, the display will change from grey to red.  
Reduce the signal amplification at your aerial.  
When the signal is weak:  
check that applicable channels have  
been selected.  
–adjust the position and direction of the aerial.  
–adjust the aerial reception with “DVB Manual Tuning” in the Setup  
menu (right).  
–check that the current digital broadcast channel is correctly  
broadcasting.  
To exit the screen  
Press [EXIT].  
RQT8859  
70  
Analogue Manual Tuning  
You can delete analogue channels and set the analogue channel  
details.  
After performing steps 1–4 (69)  
5 Press [3, 4] to select “Settings for  
Analogue Services” and press [OK].  
tings  
6 While “Manual Tuning” is highlighted,  
e
s
s
and press [OK].  
Manual Tuning  
Pos Name Ch  
Pos Name Ch  
unit’  
1
2
ARD  
ZDF  
N3  
4
2
11  
12  
13  
14  
15  
16  
17  
18  
19  
20  
3
4
5
5
8
10  
HR3  
BR3  
6
7
8
9
SELECT  
OK  
ingthe  
RETURN  
n
10  
Delete  
Cha  
To delete a programme position  
Press [3, 4, 2, 1] to select a programme position and press the  
“Red” button.  
To change the tuning settings for individual  
programme position  
Pos  
Name  
Channel  
1
ARD  
4
7 Press [3, 4, 2, 1]  
Manual  
Tuning  
Fine Tuning Auto  
Mono  
to select a  
Off  
programme position  
and press [OK].  
SELECT  
RETURN  
RETURN : leave  
Press [3, 4] to select an item and press [1].  
Pos  
Programme position in the table  
(You cannot change the programme position.)  
Name  
To enter or change the name of a TV station  
Press [3, 4, 2, 1] to enter station name and  
press [OK].  
If the station name needs a blank space, select  
the blank between “Z” and “¢”.  
Channel  
To enter newly available TV stations or change  
the channel number of an already tuned TV  
station  
Press [3, 4] or the numbered buttons to enter  
the channel number of the desired TV station.  
Wait a few moments until the desired TV station  
has been tuned.  
After the desired TV station is tuned, press [OK].  
Fine Tuning  
Mono  
To obtain the best tuning condition  
Press [3, 4] to adjust the best tuning condition  
and press [OK].  
Press [1] to return to “Auto”.  
To select the type of sound to be recorded  
Press [3, 4] to select “On” if the stereo sound is  
distorted due to inferior reception conditions, or if  
you want to record the normal (mono) sound  
during a stereo or bilingual broadcast, and press  
[OK].  
RQT8859  
71  
Changing the unit’s settings  
Refer to the control reference on page 64.  
Auto-Setup Restart  
TV System  
Change the setting to match the equipment you are connecting with,  
or to match the title when there are both PAL and NTSC titles on the  
HDD.  
You can restart auto channel setting for terrestrial digital and  
analogue channels if set up (20) fails for some reason.  
However, if you perform “Auto-Setup Restart”, the order of analogue  
channels will change.  
1
While stopped  
After performing steps 1–4 (69)  
Press [FUNCTION MENU].  
5 Press [3, 4] to select “Auto-Setup  
2 Press [3, 4] to select “To Others”  
Restart” and press [OK].  
and press [OK].  
The confirmation screen appears.  
3 Press [3, 4] to select “Setup” and  
6 Press [2, 1] to select “Yes” and  
press [OK].  
press [OK].  
4 Press [3, 4] to select “Connection”  
You can also use the following method to restart Auto-Setup.  
When the unit is on and stopped,  
Press and hold [X CH] and [CH W] on the main unit until the  
Auto-Setup screen appears.  
All the settings except for the ratings level, ratings password and  
clock settings return to the factory preset. The timer recording  
programmes are also cancelled.  
and press [1].  
5 Press [3, 4] to select “TV System”  
and press [OK].  
TV System  
Setup  
PAL  
NTSC  
Tuning  
Disc  
To return to the previous screen  
Press [RETURN].  
Picture  
Sound  
Display  
SELECT  
OK  
To exit the screen  
Press [EXIT].  
Connection  
Others  
RETURN  
6 Press [3, 4] to select the TV system  
List of TV Reception Channels  
and press [OK].  
PAL (factory preset)  
Tuner  
Channel  
VHF  
0–12  
6–12  
UHF  
CATV  
–Select when connecting to a PAL or Multi-system  
television. Titles recorded using NTSC are played as PAL  
60.  
–Select to record television programmes and PAL input from  
other equipment.  
System  
Coverage  
Australia  
Analogue  
45 MHz to  
470 MHz  
PAL–B  
DVB–T  
28–69  
27–69  
Australia  
Digital  
[HDD] Select when playing a PAL input title recorded on the  
HDD.  
NTSC  
–Select when connecting to a NTSC television. Television  
programmes cannot be recorded properly.  
–Select to record NTSC input from other equipment.  
[HDD] Select when playing a NTSC input title recorded on  
the HDD.  
7 Press [2, 1] to select “Yes” and  
press [OK].  
To return to the previous screen  
Press [RETURN].  
To exit the screen  
Press [EXIT].  
To change the setting all at once (PAL!#NTSC)  
While stopped, keep pressing [] and [< OPEN/CLOSE] on the  
main unit simultaneously for 5 or more seconds.  
[Note]  
This unit cannot record NTSC signals to discs that already have  
PAL signal recordings. (However, both types of programmes can  
be recorded onto the HDD.)  
If “NTSC” has been selected, the TV Guide system cannot be  
used.  
RQT8859  
72  
Clock Settings  
This unit usually obtains time and date information from digital broadcasts and automatically corrects the time several times a day. However, if the  
time is not set correctly use the settings listed in the method below.  
In the case of a power failure, the clock setting remains in memory for approximately 60 minutes.  
1
While stopped  
Press [FUNCTION MENU].  
tings  
2 Press [3, 4] to select “To Others” and press [OK].  
3 Press [3, 4] to select “Setup” and press [OK].  
4 Press [3, 4] to select “Others” and press [1].  
5 Press [3, 4] to select “Clock” and press [OK].  
e
s
s
unit’  
e.g., This screen appears  
while receiving a digital  
broadcast.  
Clock  
ingthe  
Automatic  
Off  
Time Zone  
Queensland  
Date  
n
Time  
Cha  
15  
:
45  
:
39  
11  
.
12  
.
2007  
Please set the clock.  
OK: access RETURN: leave  
CHANGE  
OK  
SELECT  
RETURN  
6 Press [3, 4] to select “Off” of “Automatic” and press [OK].  
7 Press [2, 1] to select the item you want to change.  
The items change as follows:  
Hour!#Minute!#Second!#Day!#Month!#Year  
^-----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------J  
Reset the clock regularly to maintain accuracy.  
(Monthly accuracy +/– 15 seconds.)  
8 Press [3, 4] to change the setting.  
You can also use the numbered buttons for setting.  
9 Press [OK] when you have finished the settings.  
The clock starts.  
To return to the previous screen  
Press [RETURN].  
To exit the screen  
Press [EXIT].  
To change the time zone  
1
2
Press [3, 4] to set “Automatic” to “On” and press [OK] in step 6.  
Press [3, 4] to select the correct time zone and press [OK].  
Auto clock setting starts. This takes a few minutes.  
“Automatic clock setting completed.screen is displayed.  
Press [RETURN] to exit the screen.  
3
Language code list Enter the code with the numbered buttons.  
Abkhazian:  
Afar:  
6566 Catalan:  
6565 Chinese:  
6570 Corsican:  
8381 Croatian:  
6577 Czech:  
6582 Danish:  
7289 Dutch:  
6583 English:  
6589 Esperanto:  
6590 Estonian:  
6665 Faroese:  
6985 Fiji:  
6765 Gujarati:  
9072 Hausa:  
6779 Hebrew:  
7282 Hindi:  
6783 Hungarian:  
6865 Icelandic:  
7876 Indonesian:  
6978 Interlingua:  
6979 Irish:  
7185 Lingala:  
7265 Lithuanian:  
7387 Macedonian:  
7273 Malagasy:  
7285 Malay:  
7383 Malayalam:  
7378 Maltese:  
7365 Maori:  
7165 Marathi:  
7384 Moldavian:  
7465 Mongolian:  
7487 Nauru:  
7578 Nepali:  
7583 Norwegian:  
7575 Oriya:  
7589 Pashto, Pushto: 8083 Spanish:  
7579 Persian:  
7585 Polish:  
7678 Rhaeto-Romance:  
Tamil:  
8465  
8484  
8469  
8472  
6679  
8473  
8479  
8482  
8475  
8487  
8575  
8582  
8590  
8673  
8679  
6789  
8779  
8872  
7473  
8979  
9085  
7684  
8277 Tatar:  
8279 Telugu:  
8285 Thai:  
8377 Tibetan:  
8365 Tigrinya:  
Afrikaans:  
Albanian:  
Amharic:  
Arabic:  
Armenian:  
Assamese:  
Aymara:  
Azerbaijani:  
Bashkir:  
Basque:  
7775 Romanian:  
7771 Russian:  
7783 Samoan:  
7776 Sanskrit:  
7784 Scots Gaelic: 7168 Tonga:  
7773 Serbian: 8382 Turkish:  
7782 Serbo-Croatian: 8372 Turkmen:  
6984 Italian:  
7779 Shona:  
7778 Sindhi:  
7865 Singhalese:  
7869 Slovak:  
7879 Slovenian:  
7982 Somali:  
8378 Twi:  
8368 Ukrainian:  
8373 Urdu:  
7079 Japanese:  
7074 Javanese:  
7073 Kannada:  
7082 Kashmiri:  
7089 Kazakh:  
7176 Kirghiz:  
7565 Korean:  
6869 Kurdish:  
6976 Laotian:  
7576 Latin:  
Bengali; Bangla:  
Finnish:  
8375 Uzbek:  
8376 Vietnamese:  
8379 Volapük:  
6983 Welsh:  
8385 Wolof:  
8387 Xhosa:  
8386 Yiddish:  
8476 Yoruba:  
8471 Zulu:  
6678 French:  
6890 Frisian:  
6672 Galician:  
6682 Georgian:  
6671 German:  
7789 Greek:  
Bhutani:  
Bihari:  
Breton:  
7065 Sundanese:  
8076 Swahili:  
8084 Swedish:  
8065 Tagalog:  
8185 Tajik:  
Bulgarian:  
Burmese:  
Byelorussian: 6669 Greenlandic:  
Cambodian: 7577 Guarani:  
7679 Portuguese:  
7665 Punjabi:  
RQT8859  
7178 Latvian, Lettish: 7686 Quechua:  
73  
Messages  
On the television  
Page  
Authorisation Error.  
You are trying to play the DivX VOD content that was purchased with a different  
38, 39  
registration code. You cannot play the content on this unit. (DivX)  
Cannot finish recording completely. The programme was copy-protected.  
25  
The HDD or disc may be full.  
The maximum number of program has been exceeded.  
Cannot playback.  
TV system is different from the  
setting.  
You tried to play a title recorded using a different encoding system from that of the TV  
system currently selected on the unit.  
Alter the “TV System” setting on this unit to suit.  
72  
To playback, please change the TV  
System in Setup.  
Cannot record to the disc.  
Unable to format.  
The disc may be dirty or scratched.  
10  
Cannot play on this unit.  
You tried to play a non-compatible image.  
Turn the unit off and re-insert the card.  
37  
13  
Cannot record. Disc is full.  
[HDD] [RAM] [-RW‹V›] [+RW] Create space by deleting any unnecessary titles.  
[Even if you delete recorded content from the DVD-R, DVD-R DL, +R or +R DL there is  
no increase in disc space. Available space on DVD-RW (DVD-Video format) and +RW  
increases only when the last recorded title is deleted.]  
45, 50,  
61  
Cannot record. Maximum number of  
titles exceeded.  
Use a new disc.  
No Disc  
The disc may be upside down.  
No folders.  
There is no compatible folder in this unit.  
7, 37  
13  
No SD CARD  
No valid SD card.  
The card is not inserted. If this message is displayed with a compatible card already  
inserted, turn off the unit, remove and then re-insert the card.  
The format of the card inserted is incomplete.  
7
Not enough space in the copy  
destination.  
Create space by deleting any unnecessary items.  
45, 49,  
50, 61  
Delete one or more items registered on the copy list to ensure that the “Destination  
Capacity” is not exceeded.  
54, 57  
4–5  
This is a non-recordable disc.  
The unit cannot record on the disc you inserted. Insert a DVD-RAM or unfinalised DVD-  
R, DVD-RW (DVD-Video format), +R or +RW.  
This disc is not formatted properly.  
Format it using DVD Management in  
FUNCTION MENU.  
You inserted an unformatted DVD-RAM, DVD-RW, +R, +R DL or +RW.  
You cannot directly record to a DVD-R DL and +R DL disc on this unit. Record to the  
HDD and then copy to the disc.  
61  
Not enough space on HDD. Space  
of 4 hours (in SP mode) is  
necessary.  
[-R]DL] [+R]DL] It is not possible to copy when there is not enough free space on the HDD  
or when the total number of the recorded titles on the HDD and the titles to be copied are  
greater than 500.  
50  
Delete unwanted titles from the HDD.  
Maximum number of titles is  
recorded on HDD. Please delete  
unnecessary titles.  
Rental Expired.  
The DivX VOD content has zero remaining plays. You cannot play it. (DivX)  
39  
The operation is prohibited by the unit or disc.  
$
RQT8859  
74  
On the unit’s display  
The following messages or service numbers appear on the unit’s display when something unusual is detected during startup and use.  
Page  
22  
DVD   
The remote control and main unit are using different codes. Change the code on the remote control.  
(“” stands for a number.)  
Press and hold [OK] and the indicated number button at the same time for more  
than 5 seconds.  
s
e
HARD ERR§  
GUIDE  
If there is no change after turning the unit on and off, consult the dealer where the unit was purchased.  
68  
sag  
TV Guide data is being downloaded.  
Me  
NoERAS  
You cannot delete items on this disc.  
The disc may be damaged. Use a new disc.  
NoREAD  
The disc is dirty or badly scratched. The unit cannot record, play, or edit.  
This message may appear when the DVD lens cleaner has finished cleaning.  
Press [< OPEN/CLOSE] on the main unit to eject the disc.  
10  
10  
NoWRIT  
You cannot write to this disc.  
The disc may be damaged. Use a new disc.  
PLEASE WAIT§  
There was a power failure or the AC plug was disconnected while the unit was on. The unit is carrying  
out its recovery process. This process restores the unit to normal operation. The unit is not broken.  
Wait until the message disappears.  
PROG FULL§  
There are already 32 timer programmes. Delete unnecessary timer programmes.  
33  
SP 35:50  
Available space on the HDD or disc.  
LP 151h  
“SP”, “LP” and the numbers  
are examples.  
The example “SP 35:50” is displayed when less than 100 hours are available and the example “LP  
151h” is displayed when over 100 hours are available.  
“SP” and “LP” are recording modes, “35:50” means “35 hours 50 minutes” and “151h” means “151  
hours”.  
SW-DL  
The unit is performing a software update.  
68  
61  
UNFORMAT§  
You inserted an unformatted DVD-RAM, DVD-RW, +RW, an unused +R, +R DL or DVD-RW (DVD-  
Video format) that has been recorded on other equipment.  
Format the disc to use it.  
However all the recorded contents on the disc are deleted.  
UNSUPPORT§  
F74  
You have inserted a disc the unit cannot play or record on.  
4–6  
The HDMI connection could not be authenticated due to a transfer malfunction.  
Consult the dealer where the unit was purchased.  
F75  
U59  
The HDMI connection could not be authenticated due to an internal data malfunction.  
Consult the dealer where the unit was purchased.  
The unit is hot.  
The unit switches to standby for safety reasons. Wait for about 30 minutes until the message  
disappears.  
Select a position with good ventilation when installing the unit. Do not block the cooling fan on the rear  
of the unit.  
U61  
(When a disc is not inserted) Displays when a malfunction has occurred during recording, playback or  
copy. This is displayed when the unit is in the recovery process to return to normal operation; it is not  
broken. Once the display disappears you can use the unit again.  
U72  
U73  
The HDMI connection acts unusually.  
–The connected equipment is not HDMI compatible.  
–The HDMI cable is too long. Please use a cable 5.0 meters or less.  
–The HDMI cable is damaged.  
U76  
HDMI cannot be output because you are connected to a model that does not support copyright  
protection.  
U80  
U81  
U99  
The unit fails to operate properly. Press [Í/I] on the main unit to switch the unit to standby mode. Now  
press [Í/I] on the main unit again to turn the unit on.  
U88  
(When a disc is inserted) Displays when there was something unusual detected with the disc while  
recording, playback or copy. This is displayed when the unit is in the recovery process to return to  
normal operation; it is not broken. Once the display disappears you can use the unit again.  
78  
H or F  
There is something unusual. (The service number displayed after H and F depends on the unit’s  
condition.)  
Check the unit using the troubleshooting guide. If the service number does not disappear, do the  
following.  
78–83  
1. Disconnect the plug from the household mains socket, wait a few seconds, then reconnect it.  
2. Press [Í/I] to turn the power on. (The unit may be fixed.)  
If the service number does not disappear despite after doing the above, request service from the  
dealer. Inform the dealer of the service number when requesting service.  
X HOLD  
The Child Lock function is activated.  
63  
Press and hold [OK] and [RETURN] simultaneously until “X HOLD” disappears.  
RQT8859  
§The message are alternately displayed.  
75  
Frequently asked questions  
Refer to the following items if you have any doubts about unit operations.  
Set up  
Page  
Which aerial is suitable for receiving  
digital terrestrial broadcasts?  
You can use your current aerial. However, depending on the area where you live, a new  
aerial may be necessary. Consult your local TV aerial installer. For more information  
Can this unit receive or record High  
Definition (HD) broadcasts?  
No, this unit cannot receive or record High Definition (HD) broadcasts.  
What equipment is necessary to play  
multi channel surround sound?  
You cannot playback multi-channel sound on this unit without other equipment. You must 16, 17  
connect this unit with an HDMI cable or an optical digital cable to an amplifier with a  
built-in (Dolby Digital, DTS or MPEG) decoder.  
Are the headphones and speakers  
directly connected to the unit?  
You cannot directly connect them to the unit. Connect through the amplifier etc.  
16, 17  
The television has both S VIDEO IN  
terminal and COMPONENT VIDEO IN  
terminals. Which terminal should I  
connect with?  
Connecting with the component video out terminal provides a more vivid picture  
compared to connecting with the S Video out terminal.  
16  
If you have an LCD/plasma television or LCD projector compatible with progressive scan,  
connect through the component video terminals for high-quality progressive video.  
If you have a CRT television or a multi system television using PAL mode that is  
compatible with progressive scan, we cannot recommend progressive output as some  
flickering can occur.  
Is my television progressive output  
compatible?  
All Panasonic televisions that have 576 (625)/50i · 50p, 480 (525)/60i · 60p input terminals  
are compatible. Consult the manufacturer if you have another brand of television.  
Disc  
Can I play DVD-Video and Video CDs  
bought in another country?  
You cannot play DVD-Video if its region number does not include “4” or “ALL.  
Refer to the disc’s jacket for more information.  
Cover  
Can a DVD-Video that does not have a  
region number be played?  
The DVD-Video region number indicates the disc conforms to a standard. You cannot play  
discs that do not have a region number. You also cannot play discs that do not conform to  
a standard.  
Please tell me about disc compatibility  
with this unit.  
This unit records and plays DVD-R, DVD-RW (DVD-Video format), +R, and +RW, and  
plays DVD-RW (DVD Video Recording format). However you cannot directly record to a  
DVD-R DL or +R DL disc on this unit (playback and copy are possible).  
This unit also records and plays high speed recording compatible DVD-R, DVD-R DL,  
DVD-RW, +R, +R DL, +RW discs.  
4–6  
Please tell me about CD-R and CD-RW This unit plays CD-R/CD-RW discs which have been recorded in one of the following  
6, 37  
compatibility with this unit.  
standards: CD-DA, Video CD, DivX, MP3 and still pictures (JPEG).  
You cannot write to a CD-R or CD-RW with this unit.  
Recording  
Can I record from a commercially  
purchased video cassette or DVD?  
Most commercially sold video cassettes and DVD are copy protected; therefore, recording  
is usually not possible.  
Can DVD-R, DVD-R DL, DVD-RW (DVD- You can play on compatible equipment such as DVD players after finalising the disc on  
Video format), +R, +R DL and +RW  
recorded on this unit be played on other  
equipment?  
this unit. However, depending on the condition of the recording, the quality of the disc and  
capabilities of the DVD player, play may not be possible.  
If you play a DVD-R DL, +R DL or +RW, use compatible equipment.  
Can I record digital audio signals using  
this unit?  
You cannot record digital signals from other equipment. The digital audio terminals on this  
unit are for output only. (The audio recorded using the unit’s DV input terminal from a  
digital video camcorder, for example, is recorded digitally.)  
Can a digital audio signal from this unit  
be recorded to other equipment?  
You can record if using the PCM signal. When recording DVD, change the “Digital Audio  
Output” settings to the following in the Setup menu.  
–PCM Down Conversion: On  
66  
–Dolby Digital/DTS/MPEG: PCM  
However, only as long as digital recording from the disc is permitted and the recording  
equipment is compatible with a sampling frequency of 48 kHz.  
You cannot record MP3 signals.  
(Analogue broadcast only)  
Can I switch to bilingual broadcast  
during recording?  
With HDD and DVD-RAM, you can. Just press [AUDIO].  
(When “Rec for High Speed Copy” is set to “Off”)  
With DVD-R, DVD-RW (DVD-Video format), +R, +RW you cannot. Change before  
recording with “Bilingual Audio Selection” in the Setup menu.  
36  
66  
51  
Can I high speed copy to a disc?  
Yes, you can. (When “Rec for High Speed Copy” was set to “On” before recording the  
programme.)  
Depending on the disc type, the maximum speed varies.  
RQT8859  
76  
TV Guide  
Page  
31  
Is it possible to programme a recording, You can manually change the start and end time of programmes in the Timer Recording  
with a start and end time that are  
different from the TV Guide system?  
menu.  
Can I receive TV Guide system data via No, only via the built-in tuner. To perform timer recordings with satellite receivers or Set  
31  
a connected satellite receiver or a Set  
Top Box?  
Top Boxes, please use your unit’s manual timer programming.  
What happens when I unplug my unit  
from the household mains socket?  
The TV Guide system data will not be updated. If the unit is disconnected from the  
household mains socket for a longer period of time, then the TV Guide data is lost. Make  
sure that the time is set correctly again.  
tions  
s
e
dqu  
e
k
s
a
y
ntl  
que  
e
Fr  
RQT8859  
77  
Troubleshooting guide  
Before requesting service, make the following checks. If you are in doubt about some of the check points, or if the solutions indicated in the chart  
do not solve the problem, consult your dealer for instructions.  
The following do not indicate a problem with this unit:  
Regular disc rotating sounds.  
Poor reception due to atmospheric conditions.  
Image disturbance during search.  
Interruptions in reception due to periodic terrestrial broadcasting  
breaks.  
A sound is heard when the HDD goes into energy save mode, or  
operations are slow to respond in energy save mode.  
Operations do not work due to a poor-quality disc. (Try again using a  
Panasonic disc.)  
The unit freezes due to one of its safety devices being activated.  
(Press and hold [Í/I] on the main unit for 10 seconds.)  
When the HDD has been automatically placed in the energy save  
mode (9), or the unit is turned on or off, there may be an  
unexpected sound. This does not indicate a problem with this unit.  
Power  
Page  
No power.  
Insert the AC mains lead securely into a known active household mains socket.  
14, 15  
The unit does not turn on  
pressing [Í DVD].  
The unit switches to standby  
mode.  
One of the unit’s safety devices is activated. Press [Í/I] on the main unit to turn the unit on.  
The power is turned off  
automatically.  
If you connected this unit to a “HDAVI Control” compatible TV with an HDMI cable, this unit  
will be automatically set to standby mode when the TV is set to standby mode.  
18  
Displays  
The display is dim.  
Change “FL Display” in the Setup menu.  
67  
73  
“0:00” is flashing on the unit’s  
display.  
Set the clock.  
The time recorded on the disc  
Times shown may disagree with actual times.  
and the available time shown do Available recording space on DVD-RW (DVD-Video format) or +RW increases only when the  
not add up. last recorded title is deleted. It does not increase if other titles are deleted.  
The displayed time of this unit is Even if you delete recorded content from the DVD-R, DVD-R DL, +R or +R DL, there is no  
different from the actual increase in disc space.  
recording time or MP3 recording More disc space than the actual recording time is used after recording or editing the DVD-R,  
time.  
DVD-R DL, +R or +R DL 200 times or more.  
While searching, the elapsed time may not display correctly.  
Compared to the actual recorded The displayed recording/play time is converted from the number of frames at 29.97 frames  
time, the elapsed time displayed  
is less.  
(Only when recording in NTSC)  
(equal to 0.999 seconds) to one second. There will be a slight difference between the time  
displayed and the actual elapsed time (e.g., actual one-hour elapsed time may display as  
approximately 59 minutes 56 seconds). This does not affect the recording.  
“U88” is displayed and the disc  
cannot be ejected.  
The unit is carrying out the recovery process. Do the following to eject the disc.  
1
Press [Í/I] on the main unit to switch the unit to standby.  
If the unit doesn’t switch to standby, press and hold [Í/I] on the main unit for about 10  
seconds. The unit is forcibly switched to standby.  
2
While the unit is off, press and hold [] and [CH W] on the main unit at the same time for  
about 5 seconds. Remove the disc.  
TV screen and video  
Television reception worsens  
after connecting the unit.  
This can occur because the signals are being divided between the unit and other equipment.  
It can be solved by using a signal booster, available from audio-visual suppliers. If it is not  
solved by using a signal booster, consult the dealer.  
The digital channel information  
or control panel does not appear.  
Select the length of time (3–10 sec.) that the “On-Screen Messages” in the Setup menu will  
be displayed.  
67  
The digital channel information will not appear during playback or recording.  
Analogue broadcasts do not support the digital channel information.  
The control panel is only displayed when connected to a TV with “HDAVI Control 2” function.  
19  
The grey background does not  
appear.  
Select “On” in “Grey Background” in the Setup menu.  
67  
43  
Picture does not appear during  
timer recording.  
Timer recordings work regardless of whether the unit is on or off. To confirm the timer  
recording is going to work properly, turn the unit on.  
The 4:3 aspect ratio picture  
expands left and right.  
Use the television to change the aspect. If your television does not have that function, set  
“Progressive” in the Picture menu to “Off”.  
Check the settings for “TV Aspect” in the Setup menu.  
67  
67  
65  
Screen size is wrong.  
If you connect an HDMI cable, set “Aspect for 4:3 Video” to “16:9” in the Setup menu.  
By setting “Aspect for Recording” to “Automatic”, there is a chance that the recording will be  
made using the wrong aspect. Match the aspect settings to the broadcast when recording.  
Set “Rec for High Speed Copy” to “On”, and set the “Aspect for Recording” to “4:3”.  
65  
It may be possible to adjust the display mode on the TV. Refer to your television’s operating  
instructions.  
RQT8859  
78  
TV screen and video (continued)  
Page  
Titles recorded with 16:9 aspect  
are stretched vertically.  
16:9 aspect programmes are recorded in 4:3 aspect in the following cases.  
[-R] [-R]DL] [-RW‹V›] If you recorded or copied using “EP” or “FR (recordings 5 hours or  
longer)” recording mode.  
–If you recorded or copied to a +R, +R DL or +RW.  
–If you recorded with the “Aspect for Recording” set to “4:3” in the Setup menu.  
When you want to record 16:9 programme in the same aspect, set “Rec for High Speed  
Copy” to “On”, and set the “Aspect for Recording” to “16:9”.  
65  
–By setting “Aspect for Recording” to “Automatic”, there is a chance that the recording will be  
made using the wrong aspect. Match the aspect settings to the broadcast when recording.  
It may be possible to adjust the display mode on the TV. Refer to your television’s operating  
instructions.  
65  
There is a lot of after-image  
when playing video.  
Set “Playback NR” in the Picture menu to “Off”.  
43  
43  
hotnguide  
s
le  
When playing DVD-Video using  
progressive output, one part of  
the picture momentarily appears  
to be doubled up.  
Set “Progressive” in the Picture menu to “Off”. This problem is caused by the editing method  
or material used on DVD-Video, but should be corrected if you use interlace output.  
oub  
r
T
There is no apparent change in  
picture quality when adjusted  
with the Picture menu in the on-  
screen menus.  
The effect is less perceivable with some types of video.  
The images from this unit do not Make sure that the television is connected to the VIDEO OUT terminal,  
14–17  
appear on the television.  
S VIDEO OUT terminal, COMPONENT VIDEO OUT terminals or HDMI AV OUT terminal on  
this unit.  
Picture is distorted.  
Make sure that the television’s input setting (e.g., AV 1) is correct.  
Progressive output is set to on but the connected television is not progressive compatible.  
Press and hold [] and [1] (PLAY) on the main unit at the same time for more than 5  
seconds to cancel this setting. The setting will change to interlace.  
The unit’s “TV System” setting differs from the TV system used by the disc now playing. While  
stopped, keep pressing [] and [< OPEN/CLOSE] on the main unit for 5 or more seconds.  
The system switches from PAL to NTSC or vice versa.  
72  
When this unit is connected with an HDMI cable, use a disc that matches with this unit’s TV  
system.  
Picture may not be seen when more than 4 devices are connected with HDMI cables.  
Reduce the number of connected devices.  
The picture is distorted during  
play, or video will not play  
correctly.  
You may be playing a TV programme recorded with poor reception or unfavorable weather  
conditions.  
The picture may be distorted or a black screen may appear briefly between recorded titles in  
the following situations:  
–between titles recorded with different recording modes.  
–between scenes recorded with different aspect ratios.  
–between scenes recorded with different resolutions.  
–between playlist chapters.  
Sound  
No sound.  
Low volume.  
Check the connections and the “Digital Audio Output” settings. Check the input mode on the  
amplifier if you have connected one.  
14–17,  
66  
Distorted sound.  
Cannot hear the desired audio  
type.  
Press [AUDIO] to select the audio.  
Turn off V.S.S. in the following cases.  
–When using discs that do not have surround sound effects such as Karaoke discs.  
–When playing bilingual broadcast programmes.  
36  
43  
Audio may not be output due to how files were created. (DivX)  
Audio may not be heard when more than 4 devices are connected with HDMI cables.  
Reduce the number of connected devices.  
The sound effects will not work when the bitstream signal is output from the HDMI AV OUT  
terminal or the OPTICAL DIGITAL AUDIO OUT terminal.  
To output audio from a device connected with an HDMI cable, set “Digital Audio Output” to  
“HDMI and Optical” in the Setup menu.  
Depending on the connected equipment, the sound may be distorted if this unit is connected  
with an HDMI cable.  
If recording to the HDD or a DVD-RAM when “Rec for High Speed Copy” is set to “On”, you  
can only record either the main or secondary audio of a bilingual broadcast.  
If you do not intend to copy the title to a DVD-R, DVD-R DL, DVD-RW (DVD-Video format),  
+R, +R DL or +RW set “Rec for High Speed Copy” in the Setup menu to “Off”.  
67  
65  
Cannot switch audio.  
You cannot switch the audio in the following cases.  
–When a DVD-R, DVD-R DL, DVD-RW (DVD-Video format), +R, +R DL or +RW disc is in the  
disc tray while DVD drive is selected.  
–When the recording mode is XP and “Audio Mode for XP Recording” is set to “LPCM”.  
–When “Rec for High Speed Copy” is set to “On”. (The default setting is “On”.)  
66  
65  
The amplifier is connected using an optical digital cable or an HDMI cable. You cannot switch 16, 17,  
the audio if “Dolby Digital” is set to “Bitstream”. Set “Dolby Digital” to “PCM” or connect using  
audio cables.  
66  
There are discs for which audio cannot be changed because of how the disc was created.  
RQT8859  
79  
Troubleshooting guide  
Operation  
Page  
21  
Cannot operate the television.  
Change the manufacturer code. Some televisions cannot be operated even if you change the  
The remote control doesn’t work.  
code.  
The remote control and main unit are using different codes. Change the code on the remote  
22  
control.  
Press and hold [OK] and the indicated number button at the same time  
for more than 5 seconds.  
The batteries are depleted. Replace them with new ones.  
You are not pointing the remote control at the main unit’s remote control signal sensor during  
operation.  
11  
Coloured glass may obstruct the signal reception/transmission.  
Don’t place the signal sensor in direct sunlight or in areas that may be subject to sunlight  
exposure.  
It may be necessary to set the code on the remote control again after changing the batteries.  
It may be necessary to set the manufacturer code again after changing the batteries.  
The child lock function is activated.  
21–22  
21  
63  
The unit is on but cannot be  
operated.  
Recording drive or playback drive has not been selected properly.  
Some operations may be prohibited by the disc.  
24, 34  
The unit is hot (“U59” appears on the display). Wait for “U59” to disappear.  
One of the unit’s safety devices may have been activated.  
Reset the unit as follows:  
1
Press [Í/I] on the main unit to switch the unit to standby.  
If the unit doesn’t switch to standby, press and hold [Í/I] on the main unit for about 10  
seconds. The unit is forcibly switched to standby.  
Alternatively, disconnect the AC mains lead, wait one minute, then reconnect it.  
Press [Í/I] on the main unit to switch it on. If the unit still cannot be operated, consult the  
dealer.  
2
HDD activation is slow.  
Cannot eject disc.  
The HDD is in energy save mode.  
9
The unit is recording.  
The unit may have a problem. While the unit is off, press and hold [] and [CH W] on the main  
unit at the same time for about 5 seconds. Remove the disc and consult the dealer.  
If the Child Lock function is activated, above operation does not work. Cancel the Child Lock  
function.  
63  
Cannot tune channels.  
Startup is slow.  
Check the connections.  
14–15  
Make sure that “Quick Start” is set to “On”.  
Startup takes time in the following situations:  
–A disc other than a DVD-RAM is inserted.  
–The clock is not set.  
68  
–Immediately after a power failure or the AC mains lead is connected.  
–When the unit is connected with an HDMI cable.  
RQT8859  
80  
Recording, timer recording and copying  
Page  
4, 5  
Cannot record.  
Cannot copy.  
You haven’t inserted a disc or the disc you inserted cannot be recorded on. Insert a disc the  
unit can record onto.  
The disc is unformatted. Format the disc. [RAM] [-RW‹V›] [+R] [+R]DL] [+RW]  
The write-protect tab on the cartridge is set to PROTECT, or the disc is protected with DVD  
Management.  
61  
60  
Some programmes have limitations on the number of times they can be recorded (CPRM).  
You cannot record when there is not enough space or when the number of titles has reached  
its limit. Delete unwanted titles or use a new disc.  
84  
45, 50,  
61  
You cannot directly record to a DVD-R DL or +R DL disc on this unit.  
Record to the HDD and then copy to the disc.  
[-R]DL] [+R]DL] In the following situations, you cannot copy. Delete unnecessary titles from the  
HDD and then copy.  
45, 50,  
61  
hotnguide  
–If there is not enough space available on the HDD (If you will copy titles from the HDD to a  
blank disc and fill the entire disc, HDD disc space equivalent to 4 hours of SP mode  
recording is necessary).  
s
le  
–If the number of recorded titles and the number of titles to be copied has exceeded 500.  
You cannot record and copy on finalised discs. However, you can record and copy again if  
you format DVD-RW.  
Due to peculiarities of DVD-R, DVD-R DL, DVD-RW (DVD-Video format), +R, +R DL and  
+RW you may be unable to record onto them if you either insert and remove the disc or  
switch the unit on and off while a disc is loaded, a total of fifty times.  
DVD-R, DVD-R DL, DVD-RW (DVD-Video format), +R, +R DL and +RW recorded on this unit  
may not be recordable on other Panasonic DVD Recorders.  
oub  
r
T
This unit cannot record NTSC signals to discs that already have PAL signal recordings.  
(However, both types of programmes can be recorded onto the HDD.) Play of discs recorded  
with both PAL and NTSC on another unit is not guaranteed.  
Digital broadcasts cannot be  
recorded or copied.  
Some digital broadcasts are copyright protected with “One time only recording”. This type of  
programme can only be recorded or copied to the HDD or a CPRM compatible DVD-RAM.  
Cannot record from external  
equipment.  
Check that the connection is correct.  
Select the input channel for the equipment you have connected.  
15, 58  
Timer recording does not work  
properly.  
The timer programme is incorrect or different timer programme times overlap. Correct the  
programme.  
33  
The programme is not in timer recording standby. (The timer icon “F” in the timer recording  
33  
list is not on.)  
Set the clock.  
73  
32  
Timer recording does not stop  
even when [] is pressed.  
Make sure that the recording drive is selected. Press [DRIVE SELECT] to select the  
recording drive.  
If you start recording immediately after turning on the unit while “Quick Start” is set to “On”,  
you cannot then stop recording for a few seconds.  
The timer programme remains  
even after recording finishes.  
The timer programme remains if set to daily or weekly.  
31  
A part or whole of a recorded  
title has been lost.  
If there is a power failure or the plug is disconnected from the household mains socket while  
recording or editing, the title may be lost or the HDD/disc may become unusable.  
You will have to format the disc ([HDD] [RAM] [-RW‹V›] [+RW]) or use a new disc. We cannot offer  
any guarantee regarding lost programmes or discs.  
61  
Cannot copy to a DVD-R, etc.  
disc using the high speed mode.  
When recording to the HDD, set “Rec for High Speed Copy” to “On” in the Setup menu. (The  
default setting is “On”.)  
[+R] [+R]DL] [+RW] If recorded in “EP” or “FR (recordings 5 hours or longer)” mode, you cannot  
perform high-speed copy.  
[+R] [+R]DL] [+RW] Titles recorded on other Panasonic DVD Recorders with “Rec for High  
Speed Copy” set to “On”, and then copied to the HDD on this unit may not copy to +R, +R DL  
or +RW discs with high-speed copy.  
65  
When copying, it takes a long  
time even when high speed  
mode is selected.  
Use a disc that is compatible with high speed recording. Even if the disc is high speed  
recording compatible, the maximum speed may not be possible due to the condition of the  
disc.  
It takes longer than normal to copy many titles.  
You cannot high speed copy to DVD-R titles longer than 6 hours when using other Panasonic  
DVD Recorders that are not compatible with EP (8 Hours) mode recording.  
An unusually loud sound is  
coming from the rotating DVD-R,  
etc.  
When recording or high speed copying to a DVD-R, DVD-R DL, DVD-RW (DVD-Video  
format), +R, +R DL and +RW the sound of the disc rotating may be louder than normal,  
however, this is not a problem.  
The DV automatic recording  
function does not work.  
If images cannot be recorded or if the recording is aborted, check the connections and DV  
equipment settings.  
58  
You cannot start recording until the images from the DV equipment appear on the television.  
Recording may not be performed as desired if the time codes on the tape in the DV  
equipment are not successive.  
Depending on the equipment, the DV automatic recording may not operate properly.  
The audio/video recordings are recorded on other than a DV tape.  
58  
RQT8859  
81  
Troubleshooting guide  
Play  
Page  
Play fails to start even when  
[1] (PLAY) is pressed.  
Play starts but then stops  
immediately.  
Insert the disc correctly with the label facing up.  
34  
10  
The disc is dirty.  
You tried to play a blank disc or disc unplayable on this unit.  
You tried to play a +RW that needs to be finalised on the equipment used for recording.  
You may be able to copy a “One time only recording” title that was recorded to DVD-RAM  
using a different Panasonic DVD Recorder to this unit’s HDD, but play is not possible due to  
copyright protection.  
4–6  
When recording to DVD-RAM using “EP (8 Hours)” mode, play may not be possible on DVD  
players that are compatible with DVD-RAM. In this case use “EP (6 Hours)” mode.  
You cannot play discs during DV automatic recording.  
65  
39  
If playing DivX VOD content, refer to the homepage where you purchased it. (DivX)  
Audio and video momentarily  
pause.  
This occurs between playlist chapters.  
This occurs between chapters and with partially deleted titles on finalised DVD-R, DVD-R DL,  
DVD-RW (DVD-Video format), +R, +R DL and +RW that have been copied using the high  
speed mode.  
This occurs as scenes change during Quick View.  
5
[-R]DL] [+R]DL] When playing a title recorded on both layers, the unit automatically switches  
between layers and plays the title in the same way as a normal programme. However, video  
and audio may momentarily cut out when the unit is switching layers.  
DVD-Video is not played.  
You have set a ratings level to limit DVD-Video play. Change this setting.  
Ensure disc is for the correct DVD-Video region number, and is not defective.  
65  
Cover  
Alternative soundtrack and  
subtitles cannot be selected.  
The languages are not recorded on the disc.  
You may not be able to use the on-screen menus to change the soundtrack and subtitles on  
some discs. Use the disc’s menus to make changes.  
35  
No subtitles.  
Subtitles are not recorded on the disc.  
Turn the subtitles on. Set “Subtitle” on the on-screen menu to “On”.  
42  
Angle cannot be changed.  
Angles can only be changed during scenes where different angles are recorded.  
You have forgotten your ratings  
password.  
You want to cancel the ratings  
level.  
The ratings level returns to the factory preset. While the disc tray is open, press [DRIVE  
SELECT] to select the DVD drive, then press and hold [¥ REC] and [1] (PLAY) on the main  
unit at the same time for 5 or more seconds (“INIT” will appear on the unit’s display).  
Quick View does not work.  
This does not work when audio is other than Dolby Digital.  
This does not work when recording is in XP or FR mode.  
The resume play function does  
not work.  
Memorized positions are cancelled when  
–press [] several times.  
–open the disc tray (excluding [HDD]).  
[SD] [CD] [VCD] turn off the power.  
–if a recording or timer recording was executed.  
The Video CD picture does not  
display properly.  
When connecting to Multi-system TV, select “NTSC” in “TV System” in the Setup menu.  
72  
When connecting to PAL TV, the lower part of the picture cannot be displayed correctly during search.  
Time Slip, Manual Skip, etc. does These functions do not work with finalised discs.  
72  
Time Slip does not work when the unit’s “TV System” settings are different from the title  
not work.  
recorded on the disc.  
It takes time before play starts.  
Picture stops.  
This is normal on DivX video. (DivX)  
Picture may stop if the DivX files are greater than 2 GB. (DivX)  
Cannot see the beginning of the (If connecting to a TV that supports VIERA Link with an HDMI cable)  
When [1] (PLAY) is pressed on this unit’s remote control, you may not be able to see the  
beginning of the title played until the picture is displayed on the TV. Using [:], return to the  
beginning of the title.  
title played.  
Edit  
Available disc space does not  
increase even after deleting a  
title.  
Available disc space does not increase after deleting on DVD-R, DVD-R DL, +R or +R DL.  
Disc space increases only when the last recorded title is deleted on DVD-RW (DVD-Video  
format) and +RW. The disc space does not increase when any other titles are deleted.  
50  
Cannot edit.  
You may not be able to edit on the HDD if there is no available space.  
Delete any unwanted titles to create empty space.  
50  
Cannot format.  
The disc is dirty. Wipe with a damp cloth and then wipe dry.  
You tried formatting a disc that you may not be able to use in this unit.  
10  
4–6  
Cannot create chapters.  
The unit writes the chapter division information to the disc when you turn it off or remove the  
disc. The information is not written if there is an interruption to the power before this.  
These operations are not possible with still pictures.  
You cannot set points if they are too close to each other. You cannot set an end point before a  
start point.  
Cannot mark the start point or  
the end point during “Partial  
Delete” operation.  
Cannot delete chapters.  
Cannot create a playlist.  
When the chapter is too short to delete, use “Combine Chapters” to make the chapter longer.  
45  
You cannot select all the chapters at once in a title if the title also includes still pictures. Select  
them individually.  
Still pictures  
Cannot display Direct Navigator  
screen.  
This screen cannot be displayed during recording or copy.  
60  
Cannot edit or format a card.  
Release the card’s protection setting. (With some cards, the “Write Protection Off” message  
sometimes appears on the screen even when protection has been set.)  
The contents of the card cannot  
be read.  
The card format is not compatible with the unit. (The contents on the card may be damaged.)  
This unit is compatible with SD Memory Cards that meet SD Card Specifications FAT 12 and  
FAT 16 formats, as well as SDHC Memory Cards in FAT 32 format.  
7, 37  
The card contains a folder structure and/or file extensions that are not compatible with this unit.  
7
Turn off and then turn on the unit again.  
You can use SD Cards with capacities from 8 MB to 4 GB.  
This unit cannot play AVCHD format motion pictures on an SD Card.  
RQT8859  
Copying, deleting and setting  
protection takes a long time.  
When there are a lot of folders and files, it may sometimes take a few hours.  
61  
When repeating copying or deleting, it may sometimes take a long time. Format the disc or card.  
82  
TV Guide  
Page  
The TV Guide System does not  
receive any data.  
Check whether the clock is properly set.  
If signal quality is bad (ghost images or limited reception), the TV Guide system may not be  
able to receive any data.  
73  
“No Data” is displayed for some Some stations are not supported by the TV Guide system.  
30, 31  
Analogue broadcasts are not supported by the TV Guide system.  
or all stations.  
Programme the Timer recording manually or via G-CODE.  
The TV Guide information is not  
displayed properly.  
There was a programme change.  
Check the current programme, e.g. on the Web site for the TV Guide system provider or  
station provider.  
Programme information about analogue broadcasts is not displayed.  
The TV Guide data transfer was  
interrupted.  
The TV Guide system shows the data that was received up to the interruption.  
The programme information may be incomplete.  
The TV Guide data is not  
updated.  
Make sure that the time is set correctly.  
68  
hotnguide  
Check whether “Off” is set under “EPG Download in Standby” and change the setting in the  
s
Setup menu.  
le  
Digital broadcast  
Digital broadcasts cannot be  
received.  
oub  
Digital broadcast may not have started in your region yet.  
r
T
The aerial may not be pointing in the direction of the TV station, or the direction of the aerial  
may have changed due to strong winds or vibration. If problem persists consult your local TV  
After DVB Auto-Setup only some Check to ensure your area is covered by DVB transmissions.  
or no DVB channels are found.  
Check that the aerial and antenna cable are designed for DVB.  
14, 15  
Use the included RF coaxial cable shown in STEP 1, Connections “A” or “B”.  
For your safety, the aerial and cable should be inspected/installed by a licenced installer that  
should comply with Australian Standard AS1417.1.  
If you live within 5-10 km of DVB transmission towers, a combined VHF/UHF aerial should be  
adequate. Outside this area, separate VHF and UHF aerials provide superior reception  
performance.  
If you live in a unit or apartment, check to ensure the Master Antenna TV (MATV) system is  
designed for analogue and DVB-T reception. Please consult your body corporate. For more  
Picture regularly breaks up on  
some channels, “No Signal”  
message is displayed.  
Check “Signal Condition”. If “Signal Quality” or “Signal Strength” are displayed in red or  
constantly changing, check aerial. If problem persists consult your local TV aerial installer.  
Check that the aerial and antenna cable are designed for DVB.  
Use the included RF coaxial cable shown in STEP 1, Connections “A” or “B”.  
For your safety, the aerial and cable should be inspected/installed by a licenced installer that  
should comply with Australian Standard AS1417.1.  
Interference (known as impulse noise) from household appliances such as light switches,  
fridges etc. may cause picture break up and/or audio distortion. Use a high quality quad  
shielded coaxial cable fly lead between this unit and antenna wall socket to minimise impulse  
noise pickup. If problem persists consult your local TV aerial installer.  
70  
14, 15  
When “No Signal” message is displayed, check aerial connection.  
Adjust the aerial reception with “DVB Manual Tuning” in the Setup menu.  
70  
Picture very infrequently breaks Electrical atmospheric interference caused by local or distant lighting storms or heavy rain  
up on some or all channels.  
with wind in “leafy” locations may cause pictures to break up and audio to mute or distort  
momentarily.  
Impulse noise interference from an infrequently used electrical appliance, or a passing  
vehicle or lawn mower with a “noisy” ignition system.  
VIERA Link  
VIERA Link doesn’t work.  
Check the HDMI cable connection. Check that “HDMI” is displayed on the front display when  
the power for the main unit is set to On.  
Make sure that “VIERA Link” is set to “On”.  
67  
Check the “HDAVI Control” settings on the connected device.  
If the connection for the equipment connected with HDMI was changed, or if there was a  
power failure or the plug was removed from the household mains socket, “HDAVI Control”  
may not work.  
In this case, perform the following operations.  
1
2
3
When the HDMI cable is connected to all equipment with the power on, turn the TV  
(VIERA) on again.  
Change the TV (VIERA) settings for the “HDAVI Control” function to off, and then set to on  
again. (For more information, see the VIERA operating instructions.)  
Switch the VIERA input to HDMI connection with this unit, and after this unit’s screen is  
displayed check that “HDAVI Control” is working.  
To reset this unit  
To return all the settings other  
than the main ones to the factory  
preset  
Select “Yes” in “Shipping Condition” in the Setup menu. All the settings except for the ratings  
level, ratings password and clock settings return to the factory preset. The timer recording  
programmes are also cancelled.  
Select “Yes” in “Default Settings” in the Setup menu. All the settings other than the tuning  
settings, clock settings, time zone settings, disc language settings, ratings level, ratings  
password, remote control code, return to the factory presets.  
Press and hold [X CH] and [CH W] on the main unit until the Auto-Setup screen appears. All  
the settings except for the ratings level, ratings password and clock settings return to the  
factory preset. The timer recording programmes are also cancelled.  
68  
68  
To reset the ratings level  
settings  
To restore the unit if it freezes  
due to one of the safety devices  
being activated  
While the disc tray is open, press [DRIVE SELECT] to select the DVD drive, then press and  
hold [¥ REC] and [1] (PLAY) on the main unit at the same time for 5 or more seconds.  
Press and hold [Í/I] on the main unit for 10 seconds. (The settings remain.)  
Other  
RQT8859  
After performing an update, you Depending on the content of the update, some settings may have returned to the preset  
can no longer receive  
broadcasts.  
values. Fix the settings again.  
83  
Glossary  
Bitstream  
Film and video  
This is the digital form of multi-channel audio data (e.g., 5.1 channel)  
before it is decoded into its various channels.  
DVD-Videos are recorded using either film or video. This unit can  
determine which type has been used, then uses the most suitable  
method of progressive output.  
Film: Recorded at 25 frames per second (PAL discs) or 24 frames  
per second (NTSC discs). (NTSC discs recorded at 30 frames  
per second as well.)  
Generally appropriate for motion picture films.  
Video: Recorded at 25 frames/50 fields per second. (PAL discs) or  
30 frames/60 fields per second (NTSC discs). Generally  
appropriate for TV drama programmes or animation.  
CPRM (Content Protection for Recordable Media)  
CPRM is technology used to protect broadcasts that are allowed to  
be recorded only once. Such broadcasts can be recorded only with  
CPRM compatible recorders and discs.  
Decoder  
A decoder restores the coded audio signals on DVDs to normal. This  
is called decoding.  
DivX  
Finalise  
DivX is a popular media technology created by DivX, Inc. DivX  
media files contain highly compressed video with high visual quality  
that maintains a relatively small file size.  
A process that makes play of a recorded CD-R, CD-RW, DVD-R, etc.  
possible on equipment that can play such media. You can finalise  
DVD-R, DVD-R DL, DVD-RW (DVD-Video format), +R, +R DL on this  
unit.  
After finalising, the disc becomes play-only and you can no longer  
record or edit. However, finalised DVD-RW can be formatted for  
recording again.  
Dolby Digital  
This is a method of coding digital signals developed by Dolby  
Laboratories. Apart from stereo (2-channel) audio, these signals can  
also be multi-channel audio. A large amount of audio information can  
be recorded on one disc using this method.  
When recording on this unit Dolby Digital (2 channel) is the default  
audio.  
Folder  
This is a place on the hard disk, disc or SD Card where groups of  
data are stored together. In the case of this unit, it refers to the place  
where still pictures (JPEG) and MPEG2 are stored.  
Down-mixing  
This is the process of remixing the multi-channel audio found on  
some discs into two channels. It is useful when you want to listen to  
the 5.1-channel audio recorded on DVDs through your television’s  
speakers. Some discs prohibit down-mixing and this unit can then  
only output the front two channels.  
Formatting  
Formatting is the process of making media such as DVD-RAM  
recordable on recording equipment.  
You can format DVD-RAM, DVD-RW (only as DVD-Video format),  
+RW, SD Cards and the HDD or unused +R and +R DL on this unit.  
Formatting permanently deletes all contents.  
Drive  
In the instance of this unit, this refers to the hard disk (HDD), disc  
(DVD) and SD Card (SD). These perform the reading and writing of  
data.  
Frames and fields  
Frames refer to the single images that constitute the video you see  
on your television. Each frame consists of two fields.  
DTS (Digital Theater Systems)  
u
r
This surround system is used in many movie theaters. There is good  
separation between the channels, so realistic sound effects are  
possible.  
Frame  
Field  
Field  
A frame still shows two fields, so there may be some blurring, but  
picture quality is generally better.  
A field still shows less picture information so it may be rougher, but  
there is no blurring.  
Dynamic range  
Dynamic range is the difference between the lowest level of sound  
that can be heard above the noise of the equipment and the highest  
level of sound before distortion occurs.  
Dynamic range compression means reducing the gap between the  
loudest and softest sounds. This means you can listen at low  
volumes but still hear dialogue clearly.  
HDD (Hard disk drive)  
This is a mass data storage device used in computers, etc. A disk  
with a surface that has been treated with magnetic fluid is spun and  
a magnetic head is brought in close proximity to facilitate the reading  
and writing of large amounts of data at high speed.  
HDMI (High Definition Multimedia Interface)  
Unlike conventional connections, it transmits uncompressed digital  
video and audio signals on a single cable. This unit supports high-  
definition video output [720p (750p), 1080i (1125i), 1080p (1125p)]  
from HDMI AV OUT terminals. To enjoy high-definition video a high  
definition compatible television is required.  
RQT8859  
84  
JPEG (Joint Photographic Experts Group)  
RGB  
This is a system used for compressing/decoding colour still pictures.  
If you select JPEG as the storage system on digital cameras, etc.,  
the data will be compressed to 1/10–1/100 of its original size. The  
benefit of JPEG is less deterioration in picture quality considering  
the degree of compression.  
This refers to the three primary colours of light, red (R), green (G),  
and blue (B) and also the method of producing video that uses them.  
By dividing the video signal into the three colours for transmission,  
noise is reduced for even higher quality images.  
Sampling frequency  
LPCM (Linear PCM)  
These are uncompressed digital signals, similar to those found on  
CDs. LPCM sound is available when recording in XP mode.  
Sampling is the process of converting the heights of sound wave  
(analog signal) samples taken at set periods into digits (digital  
encoding). Sampling frequency is the number of samples taken per  
second, so larger numbers mean more faithful reproduction of the  
original sound.  
y
r
sa  
o
l
MPEG2 (Moving Picture Experts Group)  
G
A standard for efficiently compressing and expanding colour video.  
MPEG2 is a compression standard used for DVD and satellite based  
digital broadcasting. This unit records programmes using MPEG2.  
SD Video files shot with a Panasonic SD video camera, etc. can be  
copied to the HDD or a DVD-RAM disc.  
Signal Quality  
This is the guide for checking the aerial direction. The numbered  
values displayed do not indicate the strength of the signal, but the  
quality of the signal (the signal to noise ratio, or “S/N”). The channels  
you can receive are affected by weather conditions, seasons, time  
(day/night), region, length of the cable that is connected to the aerial,  
etc.  
MP3 (MPEG Audio Layer 3)  
An audio compression method that compresses audio to  
approximately one tenth of its size without any considerable loss of  
audio quality. You can play MP3 you have recorded onto CD-R and  
CD-RW.  
Thumbnail  
This refers to a miniature representation of a picture used to display  
multiple pictures in the form of a list.  
Pan&Scan/Letterbox  
In general, DVD-Video are produced with the intention that they be  
viewed on a widescreen television (16:9 aspect ratio), so images  
often don’t fit regular (4:3 aspect ratio) televisions. Two styles of  
picture, “Pan & Scan” and “Letterbox”, deal with this problem.  
Pan & Scan: The sides are cut off so the picture fills  
the screen.  
1080i  
In one high definition image, 1080 (1125) alternating scan lines pass  
every 1/50th of a second to create an interlace image. Because  
1080i (1125i) more than doubles current television broadcasts of  
480i (525i), the detail is much clearer and creates a more realistic  
and rich image.  
1080p  
Letterbox: Black bands appear at the top and bottom  
of the picture so the picture itself appears  
in an aspect ratio of 16:9.  
In one high definition image, 1080 (1125) scan lines pass at the  
same time every 1/50th of a second to create a progressive image.  
Since progressive video does not alternate scan lines like interlace,  
there is a minimal amount of screen flicker.  
Playback control (PBC)  
720p  
If a Video CD has playback control, you can select scenes and  
information with menus.  
(This unit is compatible with version 2.0 and 1.1.)  
In one high definition image, 720 (750) scan lines pass at the same  
time every 1/50th of a second to create a progressive image. Since  
progressive video does not alternate scan lines like interlace, there  
is a minimal amount of screen flicker.  
Progressive/Interlace  
The PAL video signal standard has 576 (or 625) interlaced (i) scan  
lines, whereas progressive scanning, called 576p (or 625p), uses  
twice the number of scan lines. For the NTSC standard, these are  
called 480i (or 525i) and 480p (or 525p) respectively.  
Using progressive output, you can enjoy the high-resolution video  
recorded on media such as DVD-Video.  
Your television must be compatible to enjoy progressive video.  
Panasonic televisions with 576 (625)/50i · 50p, 480 (525)/60i · 60p  
input terminals are progressive compatible.  
Protection  
You can prevent accidental deletion by setting writing protection or  
deletion protection.  
RQT8859  
85  
Specifications  
Recording system  
DVD-RAM : DVD Video Recording format  
Television system  
Tuner system  
DVD-R : DVD-Video format§1  
Channel coverage  
DVD-R DL (Dual Layer) : DVD-Video format§1  
PAL-B  
Australia  
VHF: 0 to 12  
UHF: 28 to 69  
CATV: 45 MHz to 470 MHz  
DVD-RW : DVD-Video format§1  
+R  
+R DL (Double Layer)  
+RW  
DVB-T  
Australia  
RF converter output:  
VHF: 6 to 12  
UHF: 27 to 69  
Recordable discs  
DVD-RAM:  
2X SPEED (Ver. 2.0),  
2-3X SPEED (Ver. 2.1), 2-5X SPEED (Ver. 2.2)  
1X SPEED (Ver. 2.0), 1-4X SPEED (Ver. 2.0),  
1-8X SPEED (Ver. 2.0), 1-16X SPEED (Ver. 2.1)  
2-4X SPEED (Ver. 3.0), 2-8X SPEED (Ver. 3.0)  
1X SPEED (Ver. 1.1), 1-2X SPEED (Ver. 1.1),  
2-4X SPEED (Ver. 1.2), 2-6X SPEED (Ver. 1.2)  
2.4X SPEED (Ver. 1.0), 2.4-4X SPEED (Ver. 1.1),  
Not provided  
SD Memory Card slot: 1 pc  
SD Card  
DVD-R:  
Slot:  
Compatible media: SD Memory Card§2, SDHC Memory Card§3  
,
DVD-R DL:  
DVD-RW:  
MultiMediaCard  
Format:  
FAT 12, FAT 16§4  
(In case of SD Memory Card/MultiMediaCard)  
FAT 32§4 (In case of SDHC Memory Card)  
+R:  
2.4-8X SPEED (Ver. 1.2), 2.4-16X SPEED (Ver. 1.3)  
2.4X SPEED (Ver. 1.0), 2.4-8X SPEED (Ver. 1.1)  
2.4X SPEED (Ver. 1.1), 2.4-4X SPEED (Ver. 1.2)  
+R DL:  
+RW:  
Still picture (JPEG)  
Image file format:  
JPEG conforming DCF (Design rule for Camera File system),  
sub sampling; 4:2:2 or 4:2:0  
Recording time  
Maximum 8 hours (using 4.7 GB disc)  
XP: Approx. 1 hour, SP: Approx. 2 hours  
LP: Approx. 4 hours, EP: Approx. 6 hours/8 hours  
Number of pixels:  
Thawing time:  
Between 34 a 34 and 6144 a 4096  
Approx. 1.9 sec (6 M pixels, JPEG)  
[EX77]  
Maximum Approx. 284 hours with 160 GB HDD (EP 8 hours mode)  
Video (SD Video)  
XP: Approx. 36 hours, SP: Approx. 70 hours  
Codec:  
MPEG 2 (SD-Video Entertainment Video Profile)  
SD-Video format conforming  
LP: Approx. 138 hours, EP: Approx. 212 hours/284 hours  
[EX87]  
Maximum Approx. 443 hours with 250 GB HDD (EP 8 hours mode)  
XP: Approx. 55 hours, SP: Approx. 111 hours  
LP: Approx. 222 hours, EP: Approx. 333 hours/443 hours  
File Format:  
Video Recording conversion and transfer is possible from card  
to HDD or DVD-RAM disc.  
After Video Recording conversion and transfer to HDD or  
DVD-RAM disc, the playback is possible.  
Playable discs  
Others  
DVD-RAM : DVD Video Recording format  
DVD-R : DVD-Video format, DivX  
Region code:  
#4  
5 oC to 40 oC  
10 % to 80 % RH (no condensation)  
AC 220 to 240 V, 50 Hz  
Operating temperature:  
Operating humidity range:  
Power supply:  
Power consumption:  
Dimensions (WkDkH):  
Mass:  
DVD-R DL (Dual Layer) : DVD-Video format, DivX  
DVD-RW : DVD-Video format, DVD Video Recording format  
+R, +R DL (Double Layer), +RW  
[EX77] Approx. 35 W [EX87] Approx. 36 W  
430 mmk329 mmk59 mm  
Approx. 4.2 kg  
DVD-Video, CD-Audio (CD-DA), Video CD,  
CD-R/CD-RW (CD-DA, Video CD, MP3, JPEG, DivX)  
Internal HDD capacity  
[EX77] 160 GB  
[EX87] 250 GB  
Power consumption in standby mode:  
Approx. 2 W (Power Save mode)  
Optical pick-up  
System with 1 lens, 2 integration units  
[EX77] Approx. 16 W (Quick Start mode)  
[EX87] Approx. 17 W (Quick Start mode)  
(662 nm wavelength for DVDs, 780 nm wavelength for CDs)  
LASER specification  
Class 1 LASER Product (Pickup)  
[Note]  
Specifications are subject to change without notice.  
Wave length: (CD) 780 nm wave length, (DVD) 662 nm wave length  
Laser power:  
§1 It is compatible to a DVD-Video format after finalised.  
§2 Includes miniSD cards. (A miniSD adaptor needs to be inserted.)  
§3 Class is not supported.  
No hazardous radiation is emitted with the safety protection  
Audio  
§4 Long file name is unsupported.  
Recording system:  
Dolby Digital 2ch, Linear PCM (XP mode)  
AV1/AV2 (21 pin), AV3/AV4 (pin jack)  
Standard: 0.5 Vrms, Full scale: 2.0 Vrms at 1 kHz  
More than 10 k≠  
Audio in:  
Useable capacity will be less (SD Card).  
Input level:  
Input impedance:  
Audio out:  
AV1/AV2 (21 pin), Audio Out (pin jack)  
Standard: 0.5 Vrms, Full scale: 2.0 Vrms at 1 kHz  
Less than 1 k≠  
Output level:  
Output impedance:  
Digital audio out:  
Optical terminal (PCM, Dolby Digital, DTS)  
Video  
Video system:  
PAL colour signal, 625 lines, 50 fields  
NTSC colour signal, 525 lines, 60 fields  
MPEG2 (Hybrid VBR)  
Recording system:  
Video in (PAL/NTSC):  
AV1/AV2 (21 pin), AV3/AV4 (pin jack) 1 Vp-p 75 , termination  
S-Video in (PAL/NTSC):  
AV2 (21 pin), AV3/AV4 (S terminal) 1 Vp-p 75 , termination  
Video out (PAL/NTSC):  
AV1/AV2 (21 pin), Video Out (pin jack) 1 Vp-p 75 , termination  
S-Video out (PAL/NTSC):  
AV1 (21 pin), S-Video Out (S terminal) 1 Vp-p 75 , termination  
RGB out (PAL/NTSC):  
AV1 (21 pin) 0.7 Vp-p (PAL) 75 , termination  
Component video output (NTSC 480p/480i, PAL 576p/576i)  
Y: 1.0 Vp-p 75 , termination  
PB: 0.7 Vp-p 75 , termination  
PR: 0.7 Vp-p 75 , termination  
DV input  
IEEE 1394 Standard, 4 pin : 1 pc  
HDMI Output  
This unit supports “HDAVI Control 2” function.  
19 pin type A: 1 pc  
RQT8859  
86  
Safety precautions  
Placement  
Foreign matter  
Set the unit up on an even surface away from direct sunlight, high  
temperatures, high humidity, and excessive vibration. These  
conditions can damage the cabinet and other components, thereby  
shortening the unit’s service life.  
Do not let metal objects fall inside the unit. This can cause electric  
shock or malfunction.  
Do not let liquids get into the unit. This can cause electric shock or  
malfunction. If this occurs, immediately disconnect the unit from the  
power supply and contact your dealer.  
Do not place heavy items on the unit.  
Do not spray insecticides onto or into the unit. They contain  
flammable gases which can ignite if sprayed into the unit.  
s
n
Voltage  
o
i
t
u
a
Do not use high voltage power sources. This can overload the unit  
and cause a fire.  
Service  
ec  
r
Do not use a DC power source. Check the source carefully when  
setting the unit up on a ship or other place where DC is used.  
Do not attempt to repair this unit by yourself. If sound is  
p
y
interrupted, indicators fail to light, smoke appears, or any other  
problem that is not covered in these instructions occurs, disconnect  
the AC mains lead and contact your dealer or an authorized service  
centre. Electric shock or damage to the unit can occur if the unit is  
repaired, disassembled or reconstructed by unqualified persons.  
et  
AC mains lead protection  
af  
S
/
Ensure the AC mains lead is connected correctly and not  
damaged. Poor connection and lead damage can cause fire or  
electric shock. Do not pull, bend, or place heavy items on the lead.  
Grasp the plug firmly when unplugging the lead. Pulling the AC  
mains lead can cause electric shock.  
s
n
o
i
Extend operating life by disconnecting the unit from the power  
source if it is not to be used for a long time.  
at  
c
i
f
i
ec  
Do not handle the plug with wet hands. This can cause electric  
shock.  
p
S
Official DivX® Certified product.  
Plays all versions of DivX® video (including DivX®6) with standard  
playback of DivX® media files.  
Manufactured under license from Dolby Laboratories.  
Dolby and the double-D symbol are trademarks of Dolby  
Laboratories.  
DivX, DivX Certified, and associated logos are trademarks of  
DivX, Inc. and are used under license.  
“DTS” is a registered trademark of DTS, Inc. and “DTS  
2.0iDigital Out” is a trademark of DTS, Inc.  
HDMI, the HDMI logo and High-Definition Multimedia Interface  
are trademarks or registered trademarks of HDMI Licensing LLC.  
This product incorporates copyright protection technology that is  
protected by U.S. patents and other intellectual property rights.  
Use of this copyright protection technology must be authorized  
by Macrovision, and is intended for home and other limited  
consumer uses only unless otherwise authorized by  
HDAVI Control™ is a trademark of Matsushita Electric Industrial  
Co., Ltd.  
Macrovision. Reverse engineering or disassembly is prohibited.  
-If you see this symbol-  
SDHC Logo is a trademark.  
Portions of this product are protected under copyright law and  
are provided under license by ARIS/SOLANA/4C.  
Information on Disposal in other Countries outside the  
European Union  
This symbol is only valid in the European Union.  
If you wish to discard this product, please contact  
your local authorities or dealer and ask for the correct  
method of disposal.  
RQT8859  
87  
Index  
Direct Navigator . . . . . . . . . 34, 40, 44, 48  
Discs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4–6  
Display  
Digital channel information . . . . . . . . . 23  
Status messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43  
Divide Title . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45  
DivX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37–39, 84  
DV automatic recording . . . . . . . . . . . 58  
Partial Delete . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45  
Picture settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43, 66  
Playlist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46  
Power Save . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68  
Progressive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21, 43, 85  
Properties  
Playlist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47  
Still picture . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41  
Title . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45  
Protection  
Album . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49  
Card . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60  
Cartridge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60  
Disc . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60  
Still picture . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49  
Title . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45  
Adjust the audio quality  
(Sound menu) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43  
Adjust the picture quality  
(Picture menu) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43  
Album  
Edit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48  
Play . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40  
Angle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42  
Aspect . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20  
Audio  
Edit  
Chapter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44  
Playlists . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46  
Still picture . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48  
Title . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44  
Enabling discs to be played on other  
equipment—Finalise . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62  
Encrypted . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23  
Digital broadcast  
(DVB Multi Audio) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43  
Playback . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36  
Auto Renewal Recording . . . . . . . . . . . 33  
AV2 Input . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67  
Change Thumbnail . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45  
Channel  
Quick Start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24  
Quick View . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35  
Finalise . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5, 62, 84  
Flexible Recording . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27  
Format . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5, 61, 84  
FR (Flexible Recording Mode) . . . . . . 25  
FUNCTION MENU window . . . . . . . . . 63  
Select . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23  
Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69–71  
Chapter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36, 44  
Chasing playback . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27  
Child Lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63  
Cleaning  
Disc . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10  
Lens . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10  
Main unit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10  
Clock settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73  
Connection  
Aerial . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14, 15  
Amplifier, system component . . . . . . . . 16  
DV input terminal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58  
HDMI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17  
Television . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14–17  
Video cassette recorder . . . . . . . . . . . . 15  
Copy  
SD Card (SD Video) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55  
Still picture . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56  
Title/Playlist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51  
CPRM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 84  
Create Chapter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36, 45  
Create playlists . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46  
Ratings level settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65  
Recording . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24  
Aspect . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8, 65  
Auto Renewal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33  
DV automatic recording . . . . . . . . . . . . 58  
Flexible Recording . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27  
Important notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8  
Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25  
Relief . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33  
Timer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28–33  
Relief Recording . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33  
Remote control code . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22  
Repeat Play . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42  
Resume play function . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35  
G-CODE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30  
GUIDE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28  
HDAVI Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18–19, 67  
HDMI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17, 67, 84  
High Speed Copy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26, 65  
Initialize . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68  
JPEG . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37, 85  
Language  
Code list . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73  
Disc menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65  
Soundtrack . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42, 65  
Subtitle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42, 65  
LPCM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 66, 85  
SD Card . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7, 13  
Select the channel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23  
Setup menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 64  
Signal Condition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70  
Simultaneous rec and play . . . . . . . . . 27  
Soundtrack . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42  
Still picture  
Copy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56  
Edit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48  
Play . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40  
Subtitle  
Manual Skip . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36  
Menu  
DivX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38  
MP3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39  
Setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 64  
Mode  
Recording . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25  
Still Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 66  
MP3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37, 39  
Delete  
Album . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49  
All titles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61  
Chapter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45, 47  
Playlist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47  
Still picture . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49  
Title . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45  
Digital Audio Output settings . . . . 66, 67  
Digital broadcast  
Digital channel information . . . . . . . . . . 23  
DVB Multi Audio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43  
New service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23, 67  
Recording . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24  
Select the channel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23  
Signal Condition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70  
System Update . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68  
Timer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28  
Disc . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42  
Switch the audio/subtitles on the disc  
(Disc menu) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42  
System Update . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68  
Name  
Album . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49  
Disc . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60  
Entering text . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59  
Playlist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47  
Title . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31, 45  
New service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23, 67  
Time Slip . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36  
Timer recording . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28–33  
Tuning  
Analogue broadcast . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71  
Digital broadcast . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70  
Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71  
TV Guide. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28  
TV System (PAL/NTSC) . . . . . . . . . . . . 72  
VIERA Link . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18–19, 67  
Matsushita Electric Industrial Co., Ltd.  
p
RQT8859-L  
F0507YK0  

JVC AV 20NMG3B User Manual
JVC InteriArt AV 32H40SU User Manual
Kingston Technology MCMASTER MC133PD User Manual
Kuppersbusch USA BEDIENUNGSANWEISUNG EKI 607 2 User Manual
LG Electronics HN7413AG User Manual
Miele KM412 User Manual
Nortel Networks Nortel 4075 User Manual
Philips 14PT1686S User Manual
Philips 32FL2884 User Manual1
Philips 190S9FS User Manual